1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
50 #include <sys/types.h>
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
59 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
66 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
67 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
73 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "termhooks.h"
83 #include "intervals.h"
89 #include <X11/Shell.h>
92 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
104 extern int xlwmenu_window_p
P_ ((Widget w
, Window window
));
105 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay
P_ ((Widget
));
108 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110 extern void free_frame_menubar
P_ ((struct frame
*));
111 extern struct frame
*x_menubar_window_to_frame
P_ ((struct x_display_info
*,
116 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
119 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
124 #if defined USE_MOTIF
125 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
126 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
127 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
133 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
134 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
136 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
139 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
140 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
141 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
143 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
145 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
146 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
147 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
152 #ifndef XtNinitialState
153 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
157 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 int use_xim
= 0; /* configure --without-xim */
166 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
168 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
;
170 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
173 static int any_help_event_p
;
175 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
176 static Lisp_Object last_window
;
178 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
180 int x_use_underline_position_properties
;
182 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
184 int x_underline_at_descent_line
;
186 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
189 struct x_display_info
*x_display_list
;
191 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
192 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
193 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
194 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
196 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list
;
198 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
199 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
200 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
201 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
203 extern struct frame
*updating_frame
;
205 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
207 struct frame
*pending_autoraise_frame
;
210 /* The application context for Xt use. */
211 XtAppContext Xt_app_con
;
212 static String Xt_default_resources
[] = {0};
213 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
215 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
217 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
;
219 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
220 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
222 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
;
224 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
225 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
226 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
228 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
;
232 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
233 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
234 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
235 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
237 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
239 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
240 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
241 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
242 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
243 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
244 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
245 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
246 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
247 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
250 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
252 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph
;
253 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame
;
254 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame
;
256 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
258 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
259 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
262 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
263 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
266 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
268 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
269 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
270 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
271 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
272 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
273 it's somewhat accurate. */
275 static Time last_mouse_movement_time
;
277 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
279 static Time last_user_time
;
281 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
285 static int volatile input_signal_count
;
287 static int input_signal_count
;
290 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
292 static int x_noop_count
;
294 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
296 extern char **initial_argv
;
297 extern int initial_argc
;
299 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args
, Vsystem_name
;
301 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
303 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager
;
305 extern Lisp_Object Qeql
;
309 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
311 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers
;
313 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
315 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym
, Vx_hyper_keysym
, Vx_meta_keysym
, Vx_super_keysym
;
316 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table
;
317 static Lisp_Object Qalt
, Qhyper
, Qmeta
, Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
;
319 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms
;
320 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1
;
322 /* Used in x_flush. */
324 extern Lisp_Object Vinhibit_redisplay
;
326 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources
P_ ((Display
*, char *, char *, char *));
327 extern int x_bitmap_mask
P_ ((FRAME_PTR
, int));
329 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1
P_ ((Display
*, Colormap
, XColor
*));
330 static void x_set_window_size_1
P_ ((struct frame
*, int, int, int));
331 static const XColor
*x_color_cells
P_ ((Display
*, int *));
332 static void x_update_window_end
P_ ((struct window
*, int, int));
334 static int x_io_error_quitter
P_ ((Display
*));
335 static struct terminal
*x_create_terminal
P_ ((struct x_display_info
*));
336 void x_delete_terminal
P_ ((struct terminal
*));
337 static void x_font_min_bounds
P_ ((XFontStruct
*, int *, int *));
338 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds
P_ ((struct frame
*));
339 static void x_update_end
P_ ((struct frame
*));
340 static void XTframe_up_to_date
P_ ((struct frame
*));
341 static void XTset_terminal_modes
P_ ((struct terminal
*));
342 static void XTreset_terminal_modes
P_ ((struct terminal
*));
343 static void x_clear_frame
P_ ((struct frame
*));
344 static void frame_highlight
P_ ((struct frame
*));
345 static void frame_unhighlight
P_ ((struct frame
*));
346 static void x_new_focus_frame
P_ ((struct x_display_info
*, struct frame
*));
347 static void x_focus_changed
P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info
*,
348 struct frame
*, struct input_event
*));
349 static void x_detect_focus_change
P_ ((struct x_display_info
*,
350 XEvent
*, struct input_event
*));
351 static void XTframe_rehighlight
P_ ((struct frame
*));
352 static void x_frame_rehighlight
P_ ((struct x_display_info
*));
353 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor
P_ ((struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*));
354 static void x_draw_bar_cursor
P_ ((struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int,
355 enum text_cursor_kinds
));
357 static void x_clip_to_row
P_ ((struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int, GC
));
358 static void x_flush
P_ ((struct frame
*f
));
359 static void x_update_begin
P_ ((struct frame
*));
360 static void x_update_window_begin
P_ ((struct window
*));
361 static void x_after_update_window_line
P_ ((struct glyph_row
*));
362 static struct scroll_bar
*x_window_to_scroll_bar
P_ ((Display
*, Window
));
363 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion
P_ ((struct frame
**, Lisp_Object
*,
364 enum scroll_bar_part
*,
365 Lisp_Object
*, Lisp_Object
*,
367 static void x_check_fullscreen
P_ ((struct frame
*));
368 static void x_check_expected_move
P_ ((struct frame
*, int, int));
369 static void x_sync_with_move
P_ ((struct frame
*, int, int, int));
370 static int handle_one_xevent
P_ ((struct x_display_info
*, XEvent
*,
371 int *, struct input_event
*));
372 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
373 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
374 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed
P_ ((Display
*, char *));
377 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
383 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
384 connection may be broken. */
385 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay
))
391 Lisp_Object rest
, frame
;
392 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest
, frame
)
393 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
394 x_flush (XFRAME (frame
));
396 else if (FRAME_X_P (f
))
397 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
402 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
403 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
404 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
405 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
406 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
409 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
412 /***********************************************************************
414 ***********************************************************************/
418 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
419 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
427 struct record event_record
[100];
429 int event_record_index
;
431 record_event (locus
, type
)
435 if (event_record_index
== sizeof (event_record
) / sizeof (struct record
))
436 event_record_index
= 0;
438 event_record
[event_record_index
].locus
= locus
;
439 event_record
[event_record_index
].type
= type
;
440 event_record_index
++;
447 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
449 struct x_display_info
*
450 x_display_info_for_display (dpy
)
453 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
455 for (dpyinfo
= x_display_list
; dpyinfo
; dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
)
456 if (dpyinfo
->display
== dpy
)
464 /***********************************************************************
465 Starting and ending an update
466 ***********************************************************************/
468 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
469 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
470 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
471 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
472 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
482 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
483 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
487 x_update_window_begin (w
)
490 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
491 struct x_display_info
*display_info
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
494 set_output_cursor (&w
->cursor
);
498 if (f
== display_info
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
500 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
501 display_info
->mouse_face_defer
= 1;
503 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
505 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f
))
506 display_info
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
508 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
509 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
510 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
511 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
512 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
513 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
515 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
516 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
517 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
518 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
519 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
520 if (!NILP (display_info
->mouse_face_window
)
521 && w
== XWINDOW (display_info
->mouse_face_window
))
525 for (i
= 0; i
< w
->desired_matrix
->nrows
; ++i
)
526 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w
->desired_matrix
, i
))
529 if (i
< w
->desired_matrix
->nrows
)
530 clear_mouse_face (display_info
);
539 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
542 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w
, x
, y0
, y1
)
546 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
549 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID
);
551 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
554 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
555 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, x
, y0
, x
, y1
);
558 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
560 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
561 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
563 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
564 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
565 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
567 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
568 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
572 x_update_window_end (w
, cursor_on_p
, mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
574 int cursor_on_p
, mouse_face_overwritten_p
;
576 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w
->frame
));
578 if (!w
->pseudo_window_p
)
583 display_and_set_cursor (w
, 1, output_cursor
.hpos
,
585 output_cursor
.x
, output_cursor
.y
);
587 if (draw_window_fringes (w
, 1))
588 x_draw_vertical_border (w
);
593 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
594 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
595 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
597 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
= dpyinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
598 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
= dpyinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
599 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
602 updated_window
= NULL
;
606 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
613 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
614 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->mouse_face_defer
= 0;
618 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
624 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
625 complete update has been performed. The global variable
626 updated_window is not available here. */
629 XTframe_up_to_date (f
)
634 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
636 if (dpyinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
637 || f
== dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
640 if (dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
641 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
,
642 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_x
,
643 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_y
);
644 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
651 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
652 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
653 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
654 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
655 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
656 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
659 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row
)
660 struct glyph_row
*desired_row
;
662 struct window
*w
= updated_window
;
668 if (!desired_row
->mode_line_p
&& !w
->pseudo_window_p
)
669 desired_row
->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p
= 1;
671 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
672 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
673 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
674 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
675 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
676 overhead is very small. */
677 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
678 && desired_row
->full_width_p
679 && (f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
),
680 width
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
682 && (height
= desired_row
->visible_height
,
685 int y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, desired_row
->y
));
687 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
688 if (WINDOWP (f
->tool_bar_window
)
689 && w
== XWINDOW (f
->tool_bar_window
))
693 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
694 0, y
, width
, height
, False
);
695 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
696 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - width
,
697 y
, width
, height
, False
);
703 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w
, row
, p
)
705 struct glyph_row
*row
;
706 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params
*p
;
708 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
709 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
710 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
711 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
712 struct face
*face
= p
->face
;
715 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
716 rowY
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, row
->y
);
719 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
722 int oldVH
= row
->visible_height
;
723 row
->visible_height
= p
->h
;
724 row
->y
-= rowY
- p
->y
;
725 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, -1, gc
);
727 row
->visible_height
= oldVH
;
730 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, -1, gc
);
734 int bx
= p
->bx
, by
= p
->by
, nx
= p
->nx
, ny
= p
->ny
;
736 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
737 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
738 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
739 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
741 XSetFillStyle (display
, face
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
743 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->background
);
745 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
746 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
747 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
748 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
749 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
750 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
751 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
752 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
)))
754 int sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
758 int left
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
759 int width
= (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
)
760 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
764 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
765 if (left
+ width
== p
->x
)
766 bx
= left
+ sb_width
;
767 else if (p
->x
+ p
->wd
== left
)
771 int header_line_height
= WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w
);
773 nx
= width
- sb_width
;
774 by
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (header_line_height
,
776 ny
= row
->visible_height
;
781 if (left
+ width
== bx
)
783 bx
= left
+ sb_width
;
784 nx
+= width
- sb_width
;
786 else if (bx
+ nx
== left
)
787 nx
+= width
- sb_width
;
792 if (bx
>= 0 && nx
> 0)
793 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, face
->gc
, bx
, by
, nx
, ny
);
796 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->foreground
);
802 Pixmap pixmap
, clipmask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
803 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
));
807 bits
= (unsigned char *)(p
->bits
+ p
->dh
);
809 bits
= (unsigned char *)p
->bits
+ p
->dh
;
811 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
813 pixmap
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
, window
, bits
, p
->wd
, p
->h
,
815 ? (p
->overlay_p
? face
->background
816 : f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
818 face
->background
, depth
);
822 clipmask
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
,
823 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
,
826 gcv
.clip_mask
= clipmask
;
827 gcv
.clip_x_origin
= p
->x
;
828 gcv
.clip_y_origin
= p
->y
;
829 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
, &gcv
);
832 XCopyArea (display
, pixmap
, window
, gc
, 0, 0,
833 p
->wd
, p
->h
, p
->x
, p
->y
);
834 XFreePixmap (display
, pixmap
);
838 gcv
.clip_mask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
839 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
, &gcv
);
840 XFreePixmap (display
, clipmask
);
844 XSetClipMask (display
, gc
, None
);
849 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
850 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
851 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
855 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*terminal
)
859 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
860 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
863 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*terminal
)
869 /***********************************************************************
871 ***********************************************************************/
873 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
875 static int x_encode_char
P_ ((int, XChar2b
*, struct font_info
*, int *));
878 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
879 is not contained in the font. */
882 x_per_char_metric (font
, char2b
, font_type
)
885 int font_type
; /* unused on X */
887 /* The result metric information. */
888 XCharStruct
*pcm
= NULL
;
890 xassert (font
&& char2b
);
892 if (font
->per_char
!= NULL
)
894 if (font
->min_byte1
== 0 && font
->max_byte1
== 0)
896 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
897 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
898 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
899 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
900 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
901 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
902 if (char2b
->byte1
== 0
903 && char2b
->byte2
>= font
->min_char_or_byte2
904 && char2b
->byte2
<= font
->max_char_or_byte2
)
905 pcm
= font
->per_char
+ char2b
->byte2
- font
->min_char_or_byte2
;
909 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
910 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
911 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
912 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
914 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
915 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
919 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
921 \ = integer modulus */
922 if (char2b
->byte1
>= font
->min_byte1
923 && char2b
->byte1
<= font
->max_byte1
924 && char2b
->byte2
>= font
->min_char_or_byte2
925 && char2b
->byte2
<= font
->max_char_or_byte2
)
927 pcm
= (font
->per_char
928 + ((font
->max_char_or_byte2
- font
->min_char_or_byte2
+ 1)
929 * (char2b
->byte1
- font
->min_byte1
))
930 + (char2b
->byte2
- font
->min_char_or_byte2
));
936 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
937 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
938 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
939 if (char2b
->byte2
>= font
->min_char_or_byte2
940 && char2b
->byte2
<= font
->max_char_or_byte2
)
941 pcm
= &font
->max_bounds
;
945 || (pcm
->width
== 0 && (pcm
->rbearing
- pcm
->lbearing
) == 0))
950 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
951 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
954 x_encode_char (c
, char2b
, font_info
, two_byte_p
)
957 struct font_info
*font_info
;
960 int charset
= CHAR_CHARSET (c
);
961 XFontStruct
*font
= font_info
->font
;
963 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
964 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
966 if (font_info
->font_encoder
)
968 /* It's a program. */
969 struct ccl_program
*ccl
= font_info
->font_encoder
;
971 check_ccl_update (ccl
);
972 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset
) == 1)
974 ccl
->reg
[0] = charset
;
975 ccl
->reg
[1] = char2b
->byte2
;
980 ccl
->reg
[0] = charset
;
981 ccl
->reg
[1] = char2b
->byte1
;
982 ccl
->reg
[2] = char2b
->byte2
;
985 ccl_driver (ccl
, NULL
, NULL
, 0, 0, NULL
);
987 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
989 if (font
->max_byte1
== 0) /* 1-byte font */
990 char2b
->byte1
= 0, char2b
->byte2
= ccl
->reg
[1];
992 char2b
->byte1
= ccl
->reg
[1], char2b
->byte2
= ccl
->reg
[2];
994 else if (font_info
->encoding
[charset
])
996 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
998 int enc
= font_info
->encoding
[charset
];
1000 if ((enc
== 1 || enc
== 2)
1001 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset
) == 2)
1002 char2b
->byte1
|= 0x80;
1004 if (enc
== 1 || enc
== 3)
1005 char2b
->byte2
|= 0x80;
1009 *two_byte_p
= ((XFontStruct
*) (font_info
->font
))->max_byte1
> 0;
1011 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN
;
1016 /***********************************************************************
1018 ***********************************************************************/
1022 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1023 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1024 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*,
1026 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1027 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1028 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1029 static void x_draw_glyph_string
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1030 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1031 static void x_set_cursor_gc
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1032 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1033 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1034 static int x_alloc_lighter_color
P_ ((struct frame
*, Display
*, Colormap
,
1035 unsigned long *, double, int));
1036 static void x_setup_relief_color
P_ ((struct frame
*, struct relief
*,
1037 double, int, unsigned long));
1038 static void x_setup_relief_colors
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1039 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1040 static void x_draw_image_relief
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1041 static void x_draw_image_foreground
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*));
1042 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*, Pixmap
));
1043 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*, int,
1045 static void x_draw_relief_rect
P_ ((struct frame
*, int, int, int, int,
1046 int, int, int, int, int, int,
1048 static void x_draw_box_rect
P_ ((struct glyph_string
*, int, int, int, int,
1049 int, int, int, XRectangle
*));
1052 static void x_check_font
P_ ((struct frame
*, XFontStruct
*));
1056 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
1061 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1063 if (s
->font
== FRAME_FONT (s
->f
)
1064 && s
->face
->background
== FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
1065 && s
->face
->foreground
== FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
1067 s
->gc
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_gc
;
1070 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1074 xgcv
.background
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
1075 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
1077 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1078 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
1079 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
1080 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
1081 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
;
1082 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
1083 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
1085 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1086 if (xgcv
.background
== s
->face
->background
1087 && xgcv
.foreground
== s
->face
->foreground
)
1089 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->foreground
;
1090 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
1093 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s
->f
, s
->font
));
1094 xgcv
.font
= s
->font
->fid
;
1095 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
1096 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCFont
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
1098 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
1099 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
1102 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
1103 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1105 s
->gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
1110 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1113 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
)
1114 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1119 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1120 face_id
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->mouse_face_face_id
;
1121 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
1123 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, MOUSE_FACE_ID
);
1125 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
1126 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, s
->first_glyph
->u
.ch
);
1128 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, 0);
1129 s
->face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
1130 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s
->f
, s
->face
);
1132 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1133 if (s
->font
== s
->face
->font
)
1134 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1137 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1142 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->background
;
1143 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
1144 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s
->f
, s
->font
));
1145 xgcv
.font
= s
->font
->fid
;
1146 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
1147 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCFont
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
1149 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
1150 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
1153 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
1154 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1156 s
->gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
1159 xassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
1163 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1164 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1165 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1168 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s
)
1169 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1171 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1175 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1176 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1180 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s
)
1181 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1183 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s
->f
, s
->face
);
1185 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
)
1187 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1188 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1190 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO
)
1192 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s
);
1193 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1195 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
1197 x_set_cursor_gc (s
);
1200 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
)
1202 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
1203 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1205 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1206 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
1208 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1209 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1213 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1214 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1217 /* GC must have been set. */
1218 xassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
1222 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1223 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1226 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
)
1227 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1230 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
1231 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
1236 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1237 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1240 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s
)
1241 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1244 && s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
1247 int direction
, font_ascent
, font_descent
;
1248 XTextExtents16 (s
->font
, s
->char2b
, s
->nchars
, &direction
,
1249 &font_ascent
, &font_descent
, &cs
);
1250 s
->right_overhang
= cs
.rbearing
> cs
.width
? cs
.rbearing
- cs
.width
: 0;
1251 s
->left_overhang
= cs
.lbearing
< 0 ? -cs
.lbearing
: 0;
1256 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1259 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, x
, y
, w
, h
)
1260 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1264 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1265 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
1266 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
1267 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
1271 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1272 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1273 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1274 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1275 contains the first component of a composition. */
1278 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, force_p
)
1279 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1282 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1283 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1284 if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
1286 int box_line_width
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
1290 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1291 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
1292 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
,
1293 s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1294 s
->background_width
,
1295 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1296 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
1297 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1299 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s
->font
) < s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
1300 || s
->font_not_found_p
1301 || s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1304 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1305 s
->background_width
,
1306 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1307 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1313 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1316 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s
)
1317 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1321 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1322 of S to the right of that box line. */
1323 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1324 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1325 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1329 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1331 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1333 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; ++i
)
1335 struct glyph
*g
= s
->first_glyph
+ i
;
1336 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
,
1337 s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
, g
->pixel_width
- 1,
1339 x
+= g
->pixel_width
;
1344 char *char1b
= (char *) s
->char2b
;
1345 int boff
= s
->font_info
->baseline_offset
;
1347 if (s
->font_info
->vertical_centering
)
1348 boff
= VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s
->font
, s
->f
) - boff
;
1350 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1352 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; ++i
)
1353 char1b
[i
] = s
->char2b
[i
].byte2
;
1355 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1356 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1357 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1358 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1359 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1361 || (s
->background_filled_p
&& s
->hl
!= DRAW_CURSOR
))
1363 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1365 XDrawString16 (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
,
1366 s
->ybase
- boff
, s
->char2b
, s
->nchars
);
1368 XDrawString (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
,
1369 s
->ybase
- boff
, char1b
, s
->nchars
);
1374 XDrawImageString16 (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
,
1375 s
->ybase
- boff
, s
->char2b
, s
->nchars
);
1377 XDrawImageString (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
,
1378 s
->ybase
- boff
, char1b
, s
->nchars
);
1381 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1383 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1384 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1386 XDrawString16 (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
+ 1,
1387 s
->ybase
- boff
, s
->char2b
, s
->nchars
);
1389 XDrawString (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
+ 1,
1390 s
->ybase
- boff
, char1b
, s
->nchars
);
1395 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1398 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s
)
1399 struct glyph_string
*s
;
1403 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1404 of S to the right of that box line. */
1405 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1406 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1407 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1411 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1412 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1413 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1414 this composition. */
1416 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1417 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1418 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1421 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
,
1422 s
->width
- 1, s
->height
- 1);
1426 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, ++s
->gidx
)
1428 XDrawString16 (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
1429 x
+ s
->cmp
->offsets
[s
->gidx
* 2],
1430 s
->ybase
- s
->cmp
->offsets
[s
->gidx
* 2 + 1],
1432 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1433 XDrawString16 (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
1434 x
+ s
->cmp
->offsets
[s
->gidx
* 2] + 1,
1435 s
->ybase
- s
->cmp
->offsets
[s
->gidx
* 2 + 1],
1442 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1444 static struct frame
*x_frame_of_widget
P_ ((Widget
));
1445 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel
P_ ((Display
*, XrmValue
*, Cardinal
*,
1446 XrmValue
*, XrmValue
*, XtPointer
*));
1447 static void cvt_pixel_dtor
P_ ((XtAppContext
, XrmValue
*, XtPointer
,
1448 XrmValue
*, Cardinal
*));
1451 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1452 cannot be determined. */
1454 static struct frame
*
1455 x_frame_of_widget (widget
)
1458 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
1462 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget
));
1464 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1465 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1466 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1467 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1468 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget
))
1469 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
1471 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1472 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1473 for (tail
= Vframe_list
; GC_CONSP (tail
); tail
= XCDR (tail
))
1474 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail
))
1475 && (f
= XFRAME (XCAR (tail
)),
1477 && f
->output_data
.nothing
!= 1
1478 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
))
1479 && f
->output_data
.x
->widget
== widget
)
1486 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1487 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1488 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1489 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1492 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget
, cmap
, color
)
1497 struct frame
*f
= x_frame_of_widget (widget
);
1498 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, color
);
1502 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1503 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1504 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1505 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1506 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1507 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1510 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget
, display
, cmap
, pixel
, factor
, delta
)
1514 unsigned long *pixel
;
1518 struct frame
*f
= x_frame_of_widget (widget
);
1519 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, display
, cmap
, pixel
, factor
, delta
);
1523 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1524 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1526 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args
[] =
1528 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.screen
),
1530 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.colormap
),
1535 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1536 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1538 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1541 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1543 DPY is the display we are working on.
1545 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1546 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1547 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1548 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1550 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1551 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1553 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1554 we allocated the color or not.
1556 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1559 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy
, args
, nargs
, from
, to
, closure_ret
)
1563 XrmValue
*from
, *to
;
1564 XtPointer
*closure_ret
;
1574 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1575 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1577 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL
, NULL
);
1581 screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1582 cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1583 color_name
= (String
) from
->addr
;
1585 if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultBackground
) == 0)
1587 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1588 pixel
= WhitePixelOfScreen (screen
);
1590 else if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultForeground
) == 0)
1592 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1593 pixel
= BlackPixelOfScreen (screen
);
1595 else if (XParseColor (dpy
, cmap
, color_name
, &color
)
1596 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy
, cmap
, &color
))
1598 pixel
= color
.pixel
;
1599 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) True
;
1604 Cardinal nparams
= 1;
1606 params
[0] = color_name
;
1607 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1608 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1609 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1614 if (to
->addr
!= NULL
)
1616 if (to
->size
< sizeof (Pixel
))
1618 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1622 *(Pixel
*) to
->addr
= pixel
;
1626 cvt_string_to_pixel_value
= pixel
;
1627 to
->addr
= (XtPointer
) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1630 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1635 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1636 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1637 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1639 APP is the application context in which we work.
1641 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1642 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1643 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1645 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1648 cvt_pixel_dtor (app
, to
, closure
, args
, nargs
)
1657 XtAppWarningMsg (app
, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1659 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1662 else if (closure
!= NULL
)
1664 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1665 Screen
*screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1666 Colormap cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1667 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen
), screen
, cmap
,
1668 (Pixel
*) to
->addr
, 1);
1673 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1676 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1677 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1678 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1679 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1681 static const XColor
*
1682 x_color_cells (dpy
, ncells
)
1686 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1688 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
== NULL
)
1690 Screen
*screen
= dpyinfo
->screen
;
1693 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
1694 = XDisplayCells (dpy
, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen
));
1695 dpyinfo
->color_cells
1696 = (XColor
*) xmalloc (dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
1697 * sizeof *dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1699 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
; ++i
)
1700 dpyinfo
->color_cells
[i
].pixel
= i
;
1702 XQueryColors (dpy
, dpyinfo
->cmap
,
1703 dpyinfo
->color_cells
, dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1706 *ncells
= dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
;
1707 return dpyinfo
->color_cells
;
1711 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1712 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1715 x_query_colors (f
, colors
, ncolors
)
1720 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1722 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
)
1725 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolors
; ++i
)
1727 unsigned long pixel
= colors
[i
].pixel
;
1728 xassert (pixel
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1729 xassert (dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
].pixel
== pixel
);
1730 colors
[i
] = dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
];
1734 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), colors
, ncolors
);
1738 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1739 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1742 x_query_color (f
, color
)
1746 x_query_colors (f
, color
, 1);
1750 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1751 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1752 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1756 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy
, cmap
, color
)
1763 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
);
1766 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1767 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1768 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1769 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1771 unsigned long nearest_delta
= ~0;
1773 const XColor
*cells
= x_color_cells (dpy
, &ncells
);
1775 for (nearest
= i
= 0; i
< ncells
; ++i
)
1777 long dred
= (color
->red
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].red
>> 8);
1778 long dgreen
= (color
->green
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].green
>> 8);
1779 long dblue
= (color
->blue
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].blue
>> 8);
1780 unsigned long delta
= dred
* dred
+ dgreen
* dgreen
+ dblue
* dblue
;
1782 if (delta
< nearest_delta
)
1785 nearest_delta
= delta
;
1789 color
->red
= cells
[nearest
].red
;
1790 color
->green
= cells
[nearest
].green
;
1791 color
->blue
= cells
[nearest
].blue
;
1792 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
);
1796 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1797 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1798 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1799 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1800 XColor
*cached_color
;
1802 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
1803 && (cached_color
= &dpyinfo
->color_cells
[color
->pixel
],
1804 (cached_color
->red
!= color
->red
1805 || cached_color
->blue
!= color
->blue
1806 || cached_color
->green
!= color
->green
)))
1808 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1809 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= NULL
;
1810 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= 0;
1814 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1816 register_color (color
->pixel
);
1817 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1823 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1824 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1825 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1829 x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, color
)
1834 gamma_correct (f
, color
);
1835 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), cmap
, color
);
1839 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1840 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1841 get color reference counts right. */
1844 x_copy_color (f
, pixel
)
1846 unsigned long pixel
;
1850 color
.pixel
= pixel
;
1852 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1853 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), &color
);
1855 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1856 register_color (pixel
);
1862 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1863 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1864 get color reference counts right. */
1867 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy
, cmap
, pixel
)
1870 unsigned long pixel
;
1874 color
.pixel
= pixel
;
1876 XQueryColor (dpy
, cmap
, &color
);
1877 XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, &color
);
1879 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1880 register_color (pixel
);
1886 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1889 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1890 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1891 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1892 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1893 use an additional additive factor.
1895 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1896 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1897 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1900 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1901 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1902 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1903 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1904 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1905 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1908 x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, display
, cmap
, pixel
, factor
, delta
)
1912 unsigned long *pixel
;
1920 /* Get RGB color values. */
1921 color
.pixel
= *pixel
;
1922 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1924 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1925 xassert (factor
>= 0);
1926 new.red
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.red
);
1927 new.green
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.green
);
1928 new.blue
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.blue
);
1930 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1931 bright
= (2 * color
.red
+ 3 * color
.green
+ color
.blue
) / 6;
1933 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1934 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1935 if (bright
< HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
)
1936 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1937 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1939 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1940 double dimness
= 1 - (double)bright
/ HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
;
1941 /* The additive adjustment. */
1942 int min_delta
= delta
* dimness
* factor
/ 2;
1946 new.red
= max (0, new.red
- min_delta
);
1947 new.green
= max (0, new.green
- min_delta
);
1948 new.blue
= max (0, new.blue
- min_delta
);
1952 new.red
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.red
);
1953 new.green
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.green
);
1954 new.blue
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.blue
);
1958 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1959 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1962 if (new.pixel
== *pixel
)
1964 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1965 delta to the RGB values. */
1966 x_free_colors (f
, &new.pixel
, 1);
1968 new.red
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.red
);
1969 new.green
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.green
);
1970 new.blue
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.blue
);
1971 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1982 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1983 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1984 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1985 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1986 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1987 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1990 x_setup_relief_color (f
, relief
, factor
, delta
, default_pixel
)
1992 struct relief
*relief
;
1995 unsigned long default_pixel
;
1998 struct x_output
*di
= f
->output_data
.x
;
1999 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCLineWidth
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
2000 unsigned long pixel
;
2001 unsigned long background
= di
->relief_background
;
2002 Colormap cmap
= FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
);
2003 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
2004 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
2006 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
2007 xgcv
.line_width
= 1;
2009 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
2010 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
2011 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
2013 && relief
->allocated_p
)
2015 x_free_colors (f
, &relief
->pixel
, 1);
2016 relief
->allocated_p
= 0;
2019 /* Allocate new color. */
2020 xgcv
.foreground
= default_pixel
;
2022 if (dpyinfo
->n_planes
!= 1
2023 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, dpy
, cmap
, &pixel
, factor
, delta
))
2025 relief
->allocated_p
= 1;
2026 xgcv
.foreground
= relief
->pixel
= pixel
;
2029 if (relief
->gc
== 0)
2031 xgcv
.stipple
= dpyinfo
->gray
;
2033 relief
->gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), mask
, &xgcv
);
2036 XChangeGC (dpy
, relief
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2040 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
2043 x_setup_relief_colors (s
)
2044 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2046 struct x_output
*di
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
;
2047 unsigned long color
;
2049 if (s
->face
->use_box_color_for_shadows_p
)
2050 color
= s
->face
->box_color
;
2051 else if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
2053 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0))
2054 color
= IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0);
2059 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2060 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
2061 color
= xgcv
.background
;
2064 if (di
->white_relief
.gc
== 0
2065 || color
!= di
->relief_background
)
2067 di
->relief_background
= color
;
2068 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->white_relief
, 1.2, 0x8000,
2069 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
2070 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->black_relief
, 0.6, 0x4000,
2071 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
2076 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2077 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2078 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2079 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2080 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2081 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2085 x_draw_relief_rect (f
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
,
2086 raised_p
, top_p
, bot_p
, left_p
, right_p
, clip_rect
)
2088 int left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
;
2089 int top_p
, bot_p
, left_p
, right_p
, raised_p
;
2090 XRectangle
*clip_rect
;
2092 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
2093 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
2098 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
2100 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
2101 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2105 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
2106 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2107 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, top_y
+ i
,
2108 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, top_y
+ i
);
2112 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
2113 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2114 left_x
+ i
, top_y
+ i
, left_x
+ i
, bottom_y
- i
+ 1);
2116 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
2118 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
2120 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
2121 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2125 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
2126 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2127 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, bottom_y
- i
,
2128 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, bottom_y
- i
);
2132 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
2133 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2134 right_x
- i
, top_y
+ i
+ 1, right_x
- i
, bottom_y
- i
);
2136 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
2140 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2141 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2142 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2143 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2144 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2145 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2148 x_draw_box_rect (s
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
,
2149 left_p
, right_p
, clip_rect
)
2150 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2151 int left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
, left_p
, right_p
;
2152 XRectangle
*clip_rect
;
2156 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2157 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->box_color
);
2158 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2161 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2162 left_x
, top_y
, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2166 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2167 left_x
, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2170 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2171 left_x
, bottom_y
- width
+ 1, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2175 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2176 right_x
- width
+ 1, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2178 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2179 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2183 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2186 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
)
2187 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2189 int width
, left_x
, right_x
, top_y
, bottom_y
, last_x
, raised_p
;
2190 int left_p
, right_p
;
2191 struct glyph
*last_glyph
;
2192 XRectangle clip_rect
;
2194 last_x
= ((s
->row
->full_width_p
&& !s
->w
->pseudo_window_p
)
2195 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s
->w
)
2196 : window_box_right (s
->w
, s
->area
));
2198 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2199 last_glyph
= (s
->cmp
|| s
->img
2201 : s
->first_glyph
+ s
->nchars
- 1);
2203 width
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2204 raised_p
= s
->face
->box
== FACE_RAISED_BOX
;
2206 right_x
= (s
->row
->full_width_p
&& s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2208 : min (last_x
, s
->x
+ s
->background_width
) - 1);
2210 bottom_y
= top_y
+ s
->height
- 1;
2212 left_p
= (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2213 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2215 || s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2216 right_p
= (last_glyph
->right_box_line_p
2217 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2219 || s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2221 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2223 if (s
->face
->box
== FACE_SIMPLE_BOX
)
2224 x_draw_box_rect (s
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
,
2225 left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2228 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2229 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
,
2230 width
, raised_p
, 1, 1, left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2235 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2238 x_draw_image_foreground (s
)
2239 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2242 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2244 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2245 right of that line. */
2246 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2247 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2249 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2251 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2253 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2254 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2255 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2256 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2262 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2263 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2264 trust on the shape extension to be available
2265 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2267 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2270 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2272 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2273 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
;
2274 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
;
2275 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2276 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2278 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2281 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2282 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2283 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2284 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2285 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2286 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2290 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2292 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2295 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2296 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2297 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2298 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2299 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2300 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2302 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2303 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2304 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2305 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2306 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2307 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2308 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2310 int r
= s
->img
->relief
;
2312 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2314 s
->slice
.width
+ r
*2 - 1,
2315 s
->slice
.height
+ r
*2 - 1);
2320 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2321 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2322 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2326 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2329 x_draw_image_relief (s
)
2330 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2332 int x0
, y0
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
;
2335 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2337 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2338 right of that line. */
2339 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2340 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2342 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2344 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2346 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2347 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2348 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2349 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2351 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2352 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
)
2354 thick
= tool_bar_button_relief
>= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief
: DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF
;
2355 raised_p
= s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
;
2359 thick
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2360 raised_p
= s
->img
->relief
> 0;
2365 x1
= x
+ s
->slice
.width
+ thick
- 1;
2366 y1
= y
+ s
->slice
.height
+ thick
- 1;
2368 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2369 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2370 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, x0
, y0
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
,
2372 s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
== s
->img
->height
,
2374 s
->slice
.x
+ s
->slice
.width
== s
->img
->width
,
2379 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2382 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s
, pixmap
)
2383 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2387 int y
= s
->ybase
- s
->y
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2389 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2390 right of that line. */
2391 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2392 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2394 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2396 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2398 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2399 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2400 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2401 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2407 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2408 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2409 trust on the shape extension to be available
2410 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2412 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2416 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2417 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
- s
->slice
.x
;
2418 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
- s
->slice
.y
;
2419 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2420 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2422 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2423 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2424 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2425 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2429 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2430 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2431 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2433 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2434 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2435 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2436 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2437 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2438 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2439 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2441 int r
= s
->img
->relief
;
2443 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
- r
, y
- r
,
2444 s
->slice
.width
+ r
*2 - 1,
2445 s
->slice
.height
+ r
*2 - 1);
2450 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2451 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2452 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2456 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2457 give the rectangle to draw. */
2460 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, y
, w
, h
)
2461 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2466 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2467 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2468 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2469 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2472 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2476 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2479 s->x +-------------------------
2482 | +-------------------------
2485 | | +-------------------
2491 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s
)
2492 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2494 int box_line_hwidth
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2495 int box_line_vwidth
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
2497 Pixmap pixmap
= None
;
2500 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2501 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2502 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
>= s
->img
->height
)
2503 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2505 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2506 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2508 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
2509 if (height
> s
->slice
.height
2513 || s
->img
->pixmap
== 0
2514 || s
->width
!= s
->background_width
)
2518 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2519 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2520 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2521 Screen
*screen
= FRAME_X_SCREEN (s
->f
);
2522 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen
);
2524 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2525 pixmap
= XCreatePixmap (s
->display
, s
->window
,
2526 s
->background_width
,
2529 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2531 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2533 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2536 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2537 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2538 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, - s
->x
, - s
->y
);
2539 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2540 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2541 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2542 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0);
2547 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
,
2549 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2550 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2551 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2552 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2560 if (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2562 x
+= box_line_hwidth
;
2564 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2565 y
+= box_line_vwidth
;
2567 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, y
, s
->background_width
, height
);
2570 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2573 /* Draw the foreground. */
2576 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s
, pixmap
);
2577 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2578 XCopyArea (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2579 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
, s
->x
, s
->y
);
2580 XFreePixmap (s
->display
, pixmap
);
2583 x_draw_image_foreground (s
);
2585 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2587 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2588 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
2589 x_draw_image_relief (s
);
2593 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2596 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s
)
2597 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2599 xassert (s
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
);
2601 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
2602 && !x_stretch_cursor_p
)
2604 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2605 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2606 int width
, background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2607 int x
= s
->x
, left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2611 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2614 width
= min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s
->f
), background_width
);
2617 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, width
, s
->height
);
2619 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2620 if (width
< background_width
)
2623 int w
= background_width
- width
, h
= s
->height
;
2628 if (s
->row
->mouse_face_p
2629 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s
->w
))
2631 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
2637 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2638 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
2640 if (s
->face
->stipple
)
2642 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2643 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2644 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2645 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillSolid
);
2650 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
2651 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2652 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2653 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2657 else if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
2659 int background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2660 int x
= s
->x
, left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2662 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2663 except for header line and mode line. */
2664 if (x
< left_x
&& !s
->row
->mode_line_p
)
2666 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2669 if (background_width
> 0)
2670 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, background_width
, s
->height
);
2673 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2677 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2680 x_draw_glyph_string (s
)
2681 struct glyph_string
*s
;
2683 int relief_drawn_p
= 0;
2685 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2686 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2687 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2688 if (s
->next
&& s
->right_overhang
&& !s
->for_overlaps
)
2690 xassert (s
->next
->img
== NULL
);
2691 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s
->next
);
2692 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
->next
);
2693 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
->next
, 1);
2696 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2697 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s
);
2699 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2700 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2701 if (!s
->for_overlaps
2702 && s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2703 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
2704 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
2707 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2708 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2709 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2710 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2714 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2716 switch (s
->first_glyph
->type
)
2719 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s
);
2723 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s
);
2727 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2728 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2730 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 0);
2731 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2734 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH
:
2735 if (s
->for_overlaps
|| s
->gidx
> 0)
2736 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2738 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2739 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2746 if (!s
->for_overlaps
)
2748 /* Draw underline. */
2749 if (s
->face
->underline_p
)
2751 unsigned long tem
, h
;
2754 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2755 if (!XGetFontProperty (s
->font
, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS
, &h
))
2758 y
= s
->y
+ s
->height
- h
;
2759 if (!x_underline_at_descent_line
)
2761 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2762 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2763 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2764 specs, and its default is
2766 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2767 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2769 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2770 && XGetFontProperty (s
->font
, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION
, &tem
))
2771 y
= s
->ybase
+ (long) tem
;
2772 else if (s
->face
->font
)
2773 y
= s
->ybase
+ (s
->face
->font
->max_bounds
.descent
+ 1) / 2;
2776 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2777 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2778 s
->x
, y
, s
->background_width
, h
);
2782 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2783 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2784 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2785 s
->x
, y
, s
->background_width
, h
);
2786 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2790 /* Draw overline. */
2791 if (s
->face
->overline_p
)
2793 unsigned long dy
= 0, h
= 1;
2795 if (s
->face
->overline_color_defaulted_p
)
2796 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2797 s
->background_width
, h
);
2801 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2802 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->overline_color
);
2803 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2804 s
->background_width
, h
);
2805 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2809 /* Draw strike-through. */
2810 if (s
->face
->strike_through_p
)
2812 unsigned long h
= 1;
2813 unsigned long dy
= (s
->height
- h
) / 2;
2815 if (s
->face
->strike_through_color_defaulted_p
)
2816 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2821 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2822 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->strike_through_color
);
2823 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2825 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2829 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2830 if (!relief_drawn_p
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
)
2831 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2834 /* Reset clipping. */
2835 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2838 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2841 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f
, x
, y
, width
, height
, shift_by
)
2843 int x
, y
, width
, height
, shift_by
;
2845 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
2846 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
2847 x
, y
, width
, height
,
2851 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2855 x_delete_glyphs (f
, n
)
2863 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2864 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2867 x_clear_area (dpy
, window
, x
, y
, width
, height
, exposures
)
2874 xassert (width
> 0 && height
> 0);
2875 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, x
, y
, width
, height
, exposures
);
2879 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2882 x_clear_frame (struct frame
*f
)
2884 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2886 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f
)));
2887 output_cursor
.hpos
= output_cursor
.vpos
= 0;
2888 output_cursor
.x
= -1;
2890 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2891 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2893 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
2895 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2896 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2897 x_scroll_bar_clear (f
);
2899 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
2906 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2908 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2909 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2911 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2914 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2915 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2918 timeval_subtract (result
, x
, y
)
2919 struct timeval
*result
, x
, y
;
2921 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2922 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2923 if (x
.tv_usec
< y
.tv_usec
)
2925 int nsec
= (y
.tv_usec
- x
.tv_usec
) / 1000000 + 1;
2926 y
.tv_usec
-= 1000000 * nsec
;
2930 if (x
.tv_usec
- y
.tv_usec
> 1000000)
2932 int nsec
= (y
.tv_usec
- x
.tv_usec
) / 1000000;
2933 y
.tv_usec
+= 1000000 * nsec
;
2937 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2939 result
->tv_sec
= x
.tv_sec
- y
.tv_sec
;
2940 result
->tv_usec
= x
.tv_usec
- y
.tv_usec
;
2942 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2944 return x
.tv_sec
< y
.tv_sec
;
2956 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2957 pixels into background pixels. */
2961 values
.function
= GXxor
;
2962 values
.foreground
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
2963 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
2965 gc
= XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
2966 GCFunction
| GCForeground
, &values
);
2970 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2971 int height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, FRAME_LINES (f
));
2972 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2973 int flash_height
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
2974 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2975 int flash_left
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
2976 int flash_right
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
2980 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2981 edge it is next to. */
2982 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f
))
2984 case vertical_scroll_bar_left
:
2985 flash_left
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
2988 case vertical_scroll_bar_right
:
2989 flash_right
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
2996 width
= flash_right
- flash_left
;
2998 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2999 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3001 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3003 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3004 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f
) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
)),
3005 width
, flash_height
);
3006 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3008 (height
- flash_height
3009 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3010 width
, flash_height
);
3013 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3014 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3015 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3016 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3021 struct timeval wakeup
;
3023 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup
);
3025 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3026 wakeup
.tv_usec
+= 150000;
3027 wakeup
.tv_sec
+= (wakeup
.tv_usec
/ 1000000);
3028 wakeup
.tv_usec
%= 1000000;
3030 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3032 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3034 struct timeval current
;
3035 struct timeval timeout
;
3037 EMACS_GET_TIME (current
);
3039 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3040 if (timeval_subtract (¤t
, wakeup
, current
))
3043 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3045 timeout
.tv_usec
= 10000;
3047 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3048 select (0, NULL
, NULL
, NULL
, &timeout
);
3052 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3053 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3055 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3057 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3058 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f
) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
)),
3059 width
, flash_height
);
3060 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3062 (height
- flash_height
3063 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3064 width
, flash_height
);
3067 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3068 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3069 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3070 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3072 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
);
3080 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3083 /* Make audible bell. */
3088 struct frame
*f
= SELECTED_FRAME ();
3090 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))
3092 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3099 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), 0);
3100 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3107 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3108 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3109 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3110 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3113 XTset_terminal_window (n
)
3116 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3121 /***********************************************************************
3123 ***********************************************************************/
3125 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3126 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3129 x_ins_del_lines (f
, vpos
, n
)
3137 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3140 x_scroll_run (w
, run
)
3144 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
3145 int x
, y
, width
, height
, from_y
, to_y
, bottom_y
;
3147 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3148 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3150 window_box (w
, -1, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
);
3152 from_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->current_y
);
3153 to_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->desired_y
);
3154 bottom_y
= y
+ height
;
3158 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3159 line at the bottom. */
3160 if (from_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3161 height
= bottom_y
- from_y
;
3163 height
= run
->height
;
3167 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3169 if (to_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3170 height
= bottom_y
- to_y
;
3172 height
= run
->height
;
3177 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3181 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
3182 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3183 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
3193 /***********************************************************************
3195 ***********************************************************************/
3202 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3203 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3204 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3205 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3207 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3208 f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
3210 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3214 frame_unhighlight (f
)
3217 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3218 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3219 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3220 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3222 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3223 f
->output_data
.x
->border_tile
);
3225 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3228 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3229 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3230 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3231 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3232 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3235 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, frame
)
3236 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3237 struct frame
*frame
;
3239 struct frame
*old_focus
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3241 if (frame
!= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3243 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3244 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3245 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= frame
;
3247 if (old_focus
&& old_focus
->auto_lower
)
3248 x_lower_frame (old_focus
);
3251 selected_frame
= frame
;
3252 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame
->selected_window
)->frame
,
3254 Fselect_window (selected_frame
->selected_window
, Qnil
);
3255 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3258 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
&& dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
->auto_raise
)
3259 pending_autoraise_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3261 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
3264 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo
);
3267 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3268 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3269 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3272 x_focus_changed (type
, state
, dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
)
3275 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3276 struct frame
*frame
;
3277 struct input_event
*bufp
;
3279 if (type
== FocusIn
)
3281 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
!= frame
)
3283 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, frame
);
3284 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= frame
;
3286 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3287 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3288 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame
)
3289 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list
)
3290 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
3292 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_IN_EVENT
;
3293 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3297 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
|= state
;
3300 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3301 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3304 else if (type
== FocusOut
)
3306 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
&= ~state
;
3308 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
== frame
)
3310 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
3311 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, 0);
3315 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3316 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3321 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3322 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3324 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3327 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, event
, bufp
)
3328 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3330 struct input_event
*bufp
;
3332 struct frame
*frame
;
3334 frame
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xany
.window
);
3338 switch (event
->type
)
3343 struct frame
*focus_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
;
3345 = focus_frame
? focus_frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
: 0;
3347 if (event
->xcrossing
.detail
!= NotifyInferior
3348 && event
->xcrossing
.focus
3349 && ! (focus_state
& FOCUS_EXPLICIT
))
3350 x_focus_changed ((event
->type
== EnterNotify
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3352 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3358 x_focus_changed (event
->type
,
3359 (event
->xfocus
.detail
== NotifyPointer
?
3360 FOCUS_IMPLICIT
: FOCUS_EXPLICIT
),
3361 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3367 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3370 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo
)
3371 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3373 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
);
3376 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3377 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3378 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3380 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3381 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3382 the appropriate X display info. */
3385 XTframe_rehighlight (frame
)
3386 struct frame
*frame
;
3388 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame
));
3392 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo
)
3393 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3395 struct frame
*old_highlight
= dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
;
3397 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3399 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
3400 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)))
3401 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
))
3402 : dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
);
3403 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
))
3405 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
) = Qnil
;
3406 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3410 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
3412 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
!= old_highlight
)
3415 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight
);
3416 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
3417 frame_highlight (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
);
3423 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3425 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3427 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
)
3428 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3430 int min_code
, max_code
;
3433 XModifierKeymap
*mods
;
3435 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= 0;
3436 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= 0;
3437 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3438 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
= 0;
3439 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
= 0;
3441 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo
->display
, &min_code
, &max_code
);
3443 syms
= XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo
->display
,
3444 min_code
, max_code
- min_code
+ 1,
3446 mods
= XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo
->display
);
3448 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3449 Alt keysyms are on. */
3451 int row
, col
; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3452 int found_alt_or_meta
;
3454 for (row
= 3; row
< 8; row
++)
3456 found_alt_or_meta
= 0;
3457 for (col
= 0; col
< mods
->max_keypermod
; col
++)
3459 KeyCode code
= mods
->modifiermap
[(row
* mods
->max_keypermod
) + col
];
3461 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3465 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3469 for (code_col
= 0; code_col
< syms_per_code
; code_col
++)
3471 int sym
= syms
[((code
- min_code
) * syms_per_code
) + code_col
];
3477 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3478 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3483 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3484 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3489 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3490 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3491 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3492 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3497 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3498 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3499 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3500 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3504 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3505 if (!found_alt_or_meta
&& ((1 << row
) == LockMask
))
3506 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= LockMask
;
3507 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3508 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3517 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3518 if (! dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3520 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
;
3521 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3524 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3525 make them just meta, not alt. */
3526 if (dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3528 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
&= ~dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
;
3531 XFree ((char *) syms
);
3532 XFreeModifiermap (mods
);
3535 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3539 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo
, state
)
3540 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3543 EMACS_UINT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3544 EMACS_UINT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3545 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3546 EMACS_UINT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3549 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3550 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_alt
= XUINT (tem
);
3551 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3552 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_meta
= XUINT (tem
);
3553 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3554 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_hyper
= XUINT (tem
);
3555 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3556 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_super
= XUINT (tem
);
3559 return ( ((state
& (ShiftMask
| dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
)) ? shift_modifier
: 0)
3560 | ((state
& ControlMask
) ? ctrl_modifier
: 0)
3561 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
) ? mod_meta
: 0)
3562 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
) ? mod_alt
: 0)
3563 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
) ? mod_super
: 0)
3564 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
) ? mod_hyper
: 0));
3568 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo
, state
)
3569 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3572 EMACS_UINT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3573 EMACS_UINT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3574 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3575 EMACS_UINT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3579 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3580 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_alt
= XUINT (tem
);
3581 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3582 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_meta
= XUINT (tem
);
3583 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3584 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_hyper
= XUINT (tem
);
3585 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3586 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_super
= XUINT (tem
);
3589 return ( ((state
& mod_alt
) ? dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
: 0)
3590 | ((state
& mod_super
) ? dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
: 0)
3591 | ((state
& mod_hyper
) ? dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
: 0)
3592 | ((state
& shift_modifier
) ? ShiftMask
: 0)
3593 | ((state
& ctrl_modifier
) ? ControlMask
: 0)
3594 | ((state
& mod_meta
) ? dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
: 0));
3597 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3600 x_get_keysym_name (keysym
)
3606 value
= XKeysymToString (keysym
);
3614 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3616 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3618 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3622 construct_mouse_click (result
, event
, f
)
3623 struct input_event
*result
;
3624 XButtonEvent
*event
;
3627 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3629 result
->kind
= MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT
;
3630 result
->code
= event
->button
- Button1
;
3631 result
->timestamp
= event
->time
;
3632 result
->modifiers
= (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
3634 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
3638 XSETINT (result
->x
, event
->x
);
3639 XSETINT (result
->y
, event
->y
);
3640 XSETFRAME (result
->frame_or_window
, f
);
3646 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3647 The input handler calls this.
3649 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3650 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3651 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3652 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3654 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event
;
3655 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame
;
3658 note_mouse_movement (frame
, event
)
3660 XMotionEvent
*event
;
3662 last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
3663 last_mouse_motion_event
= *event
;
3664 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
, frame
);
3666 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame
))
3669 if (event
->window
!= FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame
))
3671 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3672 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3673 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, -1, -1);
3674 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= 0;
3679 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3680 if (frame
!= last_mouse_glyph_frame
3681 || event
->x
< last_mouse_glyph
.x
3682 || event
->x
>= last_mouse_glyph
.x
+ last_mouse_glyph
.width
3683 || event
->y
< last_mouse_glyph
.y
3684 || event
->y
>= last_mouse_glyph
.y
+ last_mouse_glyph
.height
)
3686 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3687 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3688 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
);
3689 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3690 remember_mouse_glyph (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
, &last_mouse_glyph
);
3691 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= frame
;
3699 /************************************************************************
3701 ************************************************************************/
3704 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3706 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame
)
3707 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
)))
3708 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
),
3709 last_mouse_motion_event
.x
,
3710 last_mouse_motion_event
.y
);
3715 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3716 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3718 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3719 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3720 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3721 position on the scroll bar.
3723 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3724 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3727 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3728 was at this position.
3730 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3732 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3736 XTmouse_position (fp
, insist
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, time
)
3739 Lisp_Object
*bar_window
;
3740 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
;
3742 unsigned long *time
;
3748 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar
) && insist
== 0)
3749 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, time
);
3755 Window dummy_window
;
3758 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
3760 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3761 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3762 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
3763 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
))
3764 XFRAME (frame
)->mouse_moved
= 0;
3766 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3768 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3769 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3770 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)),
3772 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3775 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3776 a different screen. */
3779 /* The position on that root window. */
3782 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3785 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3787 (unsigned int *) &dummy
);
3789 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3790 containing the pointer. */
3794 int parent_x
= 0, parent_y
= 0;
3798 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3799 structure is changing at the same time this function
3800 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3802 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
));
3804 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
)->grabbed
&& last_mouse_frame
3805 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
3807 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3808 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3809 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3811 /* From-window, to-window. */
3812 root
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame
),
3814 /* From-position, to-position. */
3815 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
3819 f1
= last_mouse_frame
;
3825 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3827 /* From-window, to-window. */
3830 /* From-position, to-position. */
3831 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
3836 if (child
== None
|| child
== win
)
3844 /* Now we know that:
3845 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3846 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3847 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3848 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3849 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3850 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3851 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3852 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3853 never use them in that case.) */
3855 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3856 f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
);
3858 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3859 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3862 && f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
3863 && win
== XtWindow (f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
))
3865 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3868 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)))
3871 x_uncatch_errors ();
3873 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3876 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
3878 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
), win
);
3882 f1
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
3888 if (f1
== 0 && insist
> 0)
3889 f1
= SELECTED_FRAME ();
3893 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3894 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3895 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3896 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3897 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3898 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3899 the frame are divided into. */
3901 remember_mouse_glyph (f1
, win_x
, win_y
, &last_mouse_glyph
);
3902 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= f1
;
3907 XSETINT (*x
, win_x
);
3908 XSETINT (*y
, win_y
);
3909 *time
= last_mouse_movement_time
;
3919 /***********************************************************************
3921 ***********************************************************************/
3923 /* Scroll bar support. */
3925 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3927 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3930 static struct scroll_bar
*
3931 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display
, window_id
)
3937 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3938 window_id
= (Window
) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display
, window_id
);
3939 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3941 for (tail
= Vframe_list
;
3942 XGCTYPE (tail
) == Lisp_Cons
;
3945 Lisp_Object frame
, bar
, condemned
;
3947 frame
= XCAR (tail
);
3948 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3949 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame
))
3952 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
3955 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3957 condemned
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
3958 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
3959 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3960 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3961 ! GC_NILP (bar
) || (bar
= condemned
,
3964 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
3965 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
== window_id
&&
3966 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == display
)
3967 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
3974 #if defined USE_LUCID
3976 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3977 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3980 x_window_to_menu_bar (window
)
3985 for (tail
= Vframe_list
;
3986 XGCTYPE (tail
) == Lisp_Cons
;
3989 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail
))))
3991 Lisp_Object frame
= XCAR (tail
);
3992 Widget menu_bar
= XFRAME (frame
)->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
;
3994 if (menu_bar
&& xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar
, window
))
4002 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4005 /************************************************************************
4007 ************************************************************************/
4009 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4011 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event
P_ ((XEvent
*, struct input_event
*));
4012 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event
P_ ((Lisp_Object
, int, int, int));
4013 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar
P_ ((struct frame
*,
4014 struct scroll_bar
*));
4015 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
P_ ((struct scroll_bar
*,
4019 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4020 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4022 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled
;
4024 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4026 static int last_scroll_bar_part
;
4028 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4029 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4032 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4034 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id
;
4036 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll
;
4038 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4039 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4040 to avoid jerkyness. */
4042 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top
;
4044 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4045 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4046 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4047 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4050 xt_action_hook (widget
, client_data
, action_name
, event
, params
,
4053 XtPointer client_data
;
4057 Cardinal
*num_params
;
4063 scroll_bar_p
= XmIsScrollBar (widget
);
4064 end_action
= "Release";
4065 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4066 scroll_bar_p
= XtIsSubclass (widget
, scrollbarWidgetClass
);
4067 end_action
= "EndScroll";
4068 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4071 && strcmp (action_name
, end_action
) == 0
4072 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4076 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4077 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0);
4078 w
= XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled
);
4080 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
)->dragging
))
4082 XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
)->dragging
= Qnil
;
4083 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4084 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w
);
4086 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4087 last_scroll_bar_part
= -1;
4089 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4090 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 0;
4093 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4095 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4096 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4098 static struct window
**scroll_bar_windows
;
4099 static int scroll_bar_windows_size
;
4102 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4103 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4104 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4105 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4108 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window
, part
, portion
, whole
)
4110 int part
, portion
, whole
;
4113 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= (XClientMessageEvent
*) &event
;
4114 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (window
);
4115 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4120 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4121 ev
->type
= ClientMessage
;
4122 ev
->message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_Scrollbar
;
4123 ev
->display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
4124 ev
->window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
4127 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4128 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4129 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4130 into that array in the event. */
4131 for (i
= 0; i
< scroll_bar_windows_size
; ++i
)
4132 if (scroll_bar_windows
[i
] == NULL
)
4135 if (i
== scroll_bar_windows_size
)
4137 int new_size
= max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size
);
4138 size_t nbytes
= new_size
* sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
;
4139 size_t old_nbytes
= scroll_bar_windows_size
* sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
;
4141 scroll_bar_windows
= (struct window
**) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows
,
4143 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows
[i
], nbytes
- old_nbytes
);
4144 scroll_bar_windows_size
= new_size
;
4147 scroll_bar_windows
[i
] = w
;
4148 ev
->data
.l
[0] = (long) i
;
4149 ev
->data
.l
[1] = (long) part
;
4150 ev
->data
.l
[2] = (long) 0;
4151 ev
->data
.l
[3] = (long) portion
;
4152 ev
->data
.l
[4] = (long) whole
;
4154 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4155 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 1;
4156 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4157 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4160 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4161 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4162 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4163 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), False
, 0, &event
);
4168 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4172 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event
, ievent
)
4174 struct input_event
*ievent
;
4176 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= (XClientMessageEvent
*) event
;
4181 w
= scroll_bar_windows
[ev
->data
.l
[0]];
4182 scroll_bar_windows
[ev
->data
.l
[0]] = NULL
;
4184 XSETWINDOW (window
, w
);
4185 f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4187 ievent
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
4188 ievent
->frame_or_window
= window
;
4191 ievent
->timestamp
= CurrentTime
;
4193 ievent
->timestamp
= XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
4195 ievent
->part
= ev
->data
.l
[1];
4196 ievent
->code
= ev
->data
.l
[2];
4197 ievent
->x
= make_number ((int) ev
->data
.l
[3]);
4198 ievent
->y
= make_number ((int) ev
->data
.l
[4]);
4199 ievent
->modifiers
= 0;
4205 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4207 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4210 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4211 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4212 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4215 xm_scroll_callback (widget
, client_data
, call_data
)
4217 XtPointer client_data
, call_data
;
4219 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4220 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*cs
= (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*) call_data
;
4221 int part
= -1, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4225 case XmCR_DECREMENT
:
4226 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4227 part
= scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4230 case XmCR_INCREMENT
:
4231 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4232 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4235 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT
:
4236 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4237 part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4240 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT
:
4241 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4242 part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4246 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4247 part
= scroll_bar_to_top
;
4250 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM
:
4251 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4252 part
= scroll_bar_to_bottom
;
4259 /* Get the slider size. */
4261 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XmNsliderSize
, &slider_size
, NULL
);
4264 whole
= XM_SB_MAX
- slider_size
;
4265 portion
= min (cs
->value
, whole
);
4266 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4267 bar
->dragging
= make_number (cs
->value
);
4271 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED
:
4277 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4278 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4279 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4283 #elif defined USE_GTK
4285 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4286 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4289 xg_scroll_callback (widget
, data
)
4293 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) data
;
4299 int part
= -1, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4300 GtkAdjustment
*adj
= GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget
));
4302 position
= gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj
);
4304 p
= g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget
), XG_LAST_SB_DATA
);
4307 p
= (gdouble
*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble
));
4309 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget
), XG_LAST_SB_DATA
, p
);
4315 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar
) return;
4317 diff
= (int) (position
- previous
);
4319 if (diff
== (int) adj
->step_increment
)
4321 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4322 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4324 else if (-diff
== (int) adj
->step_increment
)
4326 part
= scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4327 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4329 else if (diff
== (int) adj
->page_increment
)
4331 part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4332 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4334 else if (-diff
== (int) adj
->page_increment
)
4336 part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4337 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4341 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4342 whole
= adj
->upper
- adj
->page_size
;
4343 portion
= min ((int)position
, whole
);
4344 bar
->dragging
= make_number ((int)portion
);
4349 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4350 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4351 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4355 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4357 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4358 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4359 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4363 xaw_jump_callback (widget
, client_data
, call_data
)
4365 XtPointer client_data
, call_data
;
4367 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4368 float top
= *(float *) call_data
;
4370 int whole
, portion
, height
;
4373 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4375 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNshown
, &shown
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4379 portion
= shown
< 1 ? top
* whole
: 0;
4381 if (shown
< 1 && (eabs (top
+ shown
- 1) < 1.0/height
))
4382 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4383 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4384 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4385 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4387 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4389 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4391 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4392 bar
->dragging
= make_number (portion
);
4393 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4394 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4398 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4399 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4400 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4401 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4402 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4403 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4404 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4407 xaw_scroll_callback (widget
, client_data
, call_data
)
4409 XtPointer client_data
, call_data
;
4411 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4412 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4413 int position
= (long) call_data
;
4417 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4419 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4422 if (eabs (position
) >= height
)
4423 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4425 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4426 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4427 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
&& eabs (position
) <= max (5, height
/ 20))
4428 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4430 part
= scroll_bar_move_ratio
;
4432 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4433 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4434 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4435 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, position
, height
);
4438 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4440 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4442 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4443 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4447 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
)
4449 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4451 char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4454 xg_create_scroll_bar (f
, bar
, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback
),
4459 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4462 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
)
4464 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4470 char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4471 unsigned long pixel
;
4476 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4477 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4478 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNminimum
, 0); ++ac
;
4479 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNmaximum
, XM_SB_MAX
); ++ac
;
4480 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNorientation
, XmVERTICAL
); ++ac
;
4481 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNprocessingDirection
, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM
), ++ac
;
4482 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNincrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4483 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNpageIncrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4485 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4488 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNforeground
, pixel
);
4492 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4495 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNbackground
, pixel
);
4499 widget
= XmCreateScrollBar (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
,
4500 scroll_bar_name
, av
, ac
);
4502 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4503 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4505 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdragCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4507 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNincrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4509 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageDecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4511 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageIncrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4513 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoBottomCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4515 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoTopCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4518 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4519 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4521 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4522 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4523 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget
), XtWindow (widget
),
4524 f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
4526 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4528 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4529 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4530 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4531 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4532 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4533 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNorientation
, XtorientVertical
); ++ac
;
4534 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4535 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4537 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4540 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNforeground
, pixel
);
4544 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4547 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbackground
, pixel
);
4551 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4553 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4554 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4556 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4557 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4558 &pixel
, 1.2, 0x8000))
4560 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4562 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4564 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4565 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4566 &pixel
, 0.6, 0x4000))
4568 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4571 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4572 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4573 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1
4574 || f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4575 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4576 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4578 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, True
);
4582 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4583 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4584 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4586 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4588 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, False
);
4591 /* Specify the colors. */
4592 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
;
4595 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNtopShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4598 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
;
4601 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbottomShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4607 widget
= XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name
, scrollbarWidgetClass
,
4608 f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, av
, ac
);
4612 char *val
= initial
;
4613 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNscrollVCursor
, (XtPointer
) &val
,
4614 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4615 XtNarrowScrollbars
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll
,
4617 XtNpickTop
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_pick_top
, NULL
);
4618 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
|| val
== initial
)
4619 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4620 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= True
;
4621 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4622 XtVaSetValues (widget
, XtNcursorName
, "top_left_arrow", NULL
);
4626 /* Define callbacks. */
4627 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNjumpProc
, xaw_jump_callback
, (XtPointer
) bar
);
4628 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNscrollProc
, xaw_scroll_callback
,
4631 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4632 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4634 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4636 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4637 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4638 if (action_hook_id
== 0)
4639 action_hook_id
= XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con
, xt_action_hook
, 0);
4641 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4642 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar
, widget
);
4643 xwindow
= XtWindow (widget
);
4644 bar
->x_window
= xwindow
;
4648 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4651 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4652 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4656 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
)
4657 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4658 int portion
, position
, whole
;
4660 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
4663 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4665 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
)
4666 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4667 int portion
, position
, whole
;
4669 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4670 Widget widget
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
4677 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4678 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4679 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4680 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4681 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4682 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4683 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4684 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4685 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4686 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4687 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4688 portion
= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)) * 30;
4689 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4690 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4697 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
4698 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
4701 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
4705 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4706 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4708 size
= shown
* XM_SB_MAX
;
4709 size
= min (size
, XM_SB_MAX
);
4710 size
= max (size
, 1);
4712 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4713 value
= top
* XM_SB_MAX
;
4714 value
= min (value
, XM_SB_MAX
- size
);
4716 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget
, value
, size
, 0, 0, False
);
4718 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4724 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
4725 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
4729 float old_top
, old_shown
;
4731 XtVaGetValues (widget
,
4732 XtNtopOfThumb
, &old_top
,
4733 XtNshown
, &old_shown
,
4737 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4738 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
) || last_scroll_bar_part
== scroll_bar_down_arrow
)
4739 top
= max (0, min (1, top
));
4742 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4743 shown
= max (0, min (1 - top
- (2.0 / height
), shown
));
4745 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4746 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4747 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4748 if (top
!= old_top
|| shown
!= old_shown
)
4750 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
4751 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
4754 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4755 if (!xaw3d_pick_top
)
4756 shown
= min (shown
, old_shown
);
4758 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
4762 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4766 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4768 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4772 /************************************************************************
4773 Scroll bars, general
4774 ************************************************************************/
4776 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4777 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4778 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4781 static struct scroll_bar
*
4782 x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, left
, width
, height
)
4784 int top
, left
, width
, height
;
4786 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4787 struct scroll_bar
*bar
4788 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar
, x_window
, PVEC_OTHER
);
4792 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4793 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
);
4794 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4796 XSetWindowAttributes a
;
4800 a
.background_pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4801 if (a
.background_pixel
== -1)
4802 a
.background_pixel
= FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
);
4804 a
.event_mask
= (ButtonPressMask
| ButtonReleaseMask
4805 | ButtonMotionMask
| PointerMotionHintMask
4807 a
.cursor
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
;
4809 mask
= (CWBackPixel
| CWEventMask
| CWCursor
);
4811 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4812 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4813 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4814 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
4815 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
4817 window_box_height (w
), False
);
4819 window
= XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
4820 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4821 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4823 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4825 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4832 bar
->x_window
= window
;
4834 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4836 XSETWINDOW (bar
->window
, w
);
4840 bar
->height
= height
;
4843 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4844 bar
->fringe_extended_p
= 0;
4846 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4847 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
4849 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), bar
);
4850 if (!NILP (bar
->next
))
4851 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
4853 /* Map the window/widget. */
4854 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4857 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
,
4860 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4861 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4863 xg_show_scroll_bar (bar
->x_window
);
4864 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4865 Widget scroll_bar
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
4866 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar
,
4867 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4869 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4870 max (height
, 1), 0);
4871 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar
);
4872 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4874 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4875 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
4876 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4883 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4885 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4887 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4888 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4889 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4892 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4893 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4894 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4895 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4896 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4899 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, rebuild
)
4900 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4904 int dragging
= ! NILP (bar
->dragging
);
4905 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
4906 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4907 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
4909 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4911 && start
== bar
->start
4918 int inside_width
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f
, bar
->width
);
4919 int inside_height
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f
, bar
->height
);
4920 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
4922 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4923 the distance between start and end. */
4925 int length
= end
- start
;
4929 else if (start
> top_range
)
4931 end
= start
+ length
;
4935 else if (end
> top_range
&& ! dragging
)
4939 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4943 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4944 if (end
> top_range
)
4947 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4948 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4949 that many pixels tall. */
4950 end
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
;
4952 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4953 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4955 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
4956 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4957 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
4958 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
,
4959 inside_width
, start
,
4962 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4963 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
4964 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
4965 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
4967 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4968 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
4969 /* x, y, width, height */
4970 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
4971 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ start
,
4972 inside_width
, end
- start
);
4974 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4975 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
4976 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
4977 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
4979 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4980 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4981 if (end
< inside_height
)
4982 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
4983 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4984 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
4985 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ end
,
4986 inside_width
, inside_height
- end
,
4994 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4996 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5000 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar
)
5001 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5003 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5006 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5008 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f
, bar
->x_window
);
5009 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5010 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
));
5011 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5013 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
5016 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5017 XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->vertical_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
5023 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5024 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5025 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5029 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w
, portion
, whole
, position
)
5031 int portion
, whole
, position
;
5033 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5034 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5035 int top
, height
, left
, sb_left
, width
, sb_width
;
5036 int window_y
, window_height
;
5037 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5038 int fringe_extended_p
;
5041 /* Get window dimensions. */
5042 window_box (w
, -1, 0, &window_y
, 0, &window_height
);
5044 width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
5045 height
= window_height
;
5047 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5048 left
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
5050 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5051 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5052 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
) > 0)
5053 sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
5057 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5058 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5059 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
))
5060 sb_left
= left
+ (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
) ? width
- sb_width
: 0);
5062 sb_left
= left
+ (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
) ? 0 : width
- sb_width
);
5064 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
))
5065 sb_left
= left
+ width
- sb_width
;
5070 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5071 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
5072 fringe_extended_p
= (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
5073 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w
)
5074 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w
)
5075 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w
) == 0));
5077 fringe_extended_p
= (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
5078 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w
)
5079 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w
)
5080 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w
) == 0));
5083 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5084 if (NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5086 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5089 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5090 if (fringe_extended_p
)
5091 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5092 sb_left
, top
, sb_width
, height
, False
);
5095 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5096 left
, top
, width
, height
, False
);
5100 bar
= x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, sb_left
, sb_width
, height
);
5104 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5105 unsigned int mask
= 0;
5107 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5111 if (sb_left
!= bar
->left
)
5113 if (top
!= bar
->top
)
5115 if (sb_width
!= bar
->width
)
5117 if (height
!= bar
->height
)
5120 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5122 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5123 if (mask
|| bar
->fringe_extended_p
!= fringe_extended_p
)
5125 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5126 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5127 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5129 if (fringe_extended_p
)
5130 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5131 sb_left
, top
, sb_width
, height
, False
);
5133 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5134 left
, top
, width
, height
, False
);
5137 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
,
5140 sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5141 sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
*2,
5143 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5144 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
),
5145 sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5147 sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
5148 max (height
, 1), 0);
5149 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5151 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5153 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5154 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5155 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
)
5157 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5158 left
, top
, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5160 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5161 left
+ width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5162 top
, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5166 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5167 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5168 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5171 int area_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
5172 int rest
= area_width
- sb_width
;
5173 if (rest
> 0 && height
> 0)
5175 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
5176 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5177 left
+ area_width
- rest
, top
,
5178 rest
, height
, False
);
5180 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5181 left
, top
, rest
, height
, False
);
5185 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5190 wc
.x
= sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
5192 wc
.width
= sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2;
5194 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
,
5198 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5200 /* Remember new settings. */
5201 bar
->left
= sb_left
;
5203 bar
->width
= sb_width
;
5204 bar
->height
= height
;
5209 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5210 bar
->fringe_extended_p
= fringe_extended_p
;
5212 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5213 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5214 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5216 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5218 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, height
);
5221 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, 0, top_range
, 0);
5224 int start
= ((double) position
* top_range
) / whole
;
5225 int end
= ((double) (position
+ portion
) * top_range
) / whole
;
5226 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, 0);
5229 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5231 XSETVECTOR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
, bar
);
5235 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5236 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5237 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5238 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5239 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5240 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5241 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5243 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5244 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5245 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5248 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame
)
5251 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5252 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5255 bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5256 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
;
5257 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5258 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->prev
= Qnil
;
5259 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5260 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
))->prev
= bar
;
5261 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
) = bar
;
5266 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5267 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5270 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window
)
5271 struct window
*window
;
5273 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5276 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5277 if (NILP (window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5280 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (window
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5282 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5283 f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window
));
5284 if (NILP (bar
->prev
))
5286 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5288 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5289 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5291 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
),
5292 window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5293 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
) = bar
->next
;
5295 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5296 one or the other! */
5300 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->prev
)->next
= bar
->next
;
5302 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
5303 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
= bar
->prev
;
5305 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5307 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), bar
);
5308 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
5309 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
5312 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5313 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5316 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f
)
5319 Lisp_Object bar
, next
;
5321 bar
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5323 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5324 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5325 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
) = Qnil
;
5327 for (; ! NILP (bar
); bar
= next
)
5329 struct scroll_bar
*b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
5331 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
5334 b
->next
= b
->prev
= Qnil
;
5337 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5338 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5342 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5343 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5344 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5346 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5350 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar
, event
)
5351 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5354 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5355 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5356 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
5357 int width_trim
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
5361 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, bar
->start
, bar
->end
, 1);
5363 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5364 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5365 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5366 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5368 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5369 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5371 /* x, y, width, height */
5373 bar
->width
- 1 - width_trim
- width_trim
,
5376 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5377 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5378 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5379 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5384 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5386 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5387 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5389 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5394 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, event
, emacs_event
)
5395 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5397 struct input_event
*emacs_event
;
5399 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar
->window
))
5402 emacs_event
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
5403 emacs_event
->code
= event
->xbutton
.button
- Button1
;
5404 emacs_event
->modifiers
5405 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5406 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)))),
5407 event
->xbutton
.state
)
5408 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
5411 emacs_event
->frame_or_window
= bar
->window
;
5412 emacs_event
->arg
= Qnil
;
5413 emacs_event
->timestamp
= event
->xbutton
.time
;
5416 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5418 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f
, bar
->height
);
5421 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5422 int y
= event
->xbutton
.y
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
5425 if (y
> top_range
) y
= top_range
;
5428 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
5429 else if (y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
5430 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5432 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
5434 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5435 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5436 whether or not we're dragging. */
5438 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5440 if (event
->type
== ButtonPress
5441 && emacs_event
->part
== scroll_bar_handle
)
5442 XSETINT (bar
->dragging
, y
- bar
->start
);
5445 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5446 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5447 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
5448 && ! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5450 int new_start
= y
- XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5451 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
5453 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
5454 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
5458 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5460 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5462 if (emacs_event
->part
== scroll_bar_handle
)
5463 emacs_event
->x
= bar
->start
;
5465 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, y
);
5467 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, y
);
5470 XSETINT (emacs_event
->y
, top_range
);
5474 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5476 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5478 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5482 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar
, event
)
5483 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5486 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->frame
);
5488 last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->xmotion
.time
;
5491 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar
, bar
);
5493 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5494 if (! GC_NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5496 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5497 int new_start
= event
->xmotion
.y
- XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5499 if (new_start
!= bar
->start
)
5501 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
5503 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
5508 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5510 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5511 on the scroll bar. */
5514 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, time
)
5516 Lisp_Object
*bar_window
;
5517 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
;
5519 unsigned long *time
;
5521 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar
);
5522 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5523 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5525 Window dummy_window
;
5527 unsigned int dummy_mask
;
5531 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5533 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5535 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5536 &dummy_window
, &dummy_window
,
5537 &dummy_coord
, &dummy_coord
,
5539 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5542 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5549 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f
, bar
->height
);
5552 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5554 win_y
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
5556 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5557 win_y
-= XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5561 if (win_y
> top_range
)
5565 *bar_window
= bar
->window
;
5567 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5568 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5569 else if (win_y
< bar
->start
)
5570 *part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
5571 else if (win_y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
5572 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5574 *part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
5576 XSETINT (*x
, win_y
);
5577 XSETINT (*y
, top_range
);
5580 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
5583 *time
= last_mouse_movement_time
;
5589 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5590 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5591 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5595 x_scroll_bar_clear (f
)
5598 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5601 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5602 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5603 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5604 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
))
5605 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); VECTORP (bar
);
5606 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
5607 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5608 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
,
5610 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5614 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5617 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5618 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5619 sometimes don't work. */
5621 static Time enter_timestamp
;
5624 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5625 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5626 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5627 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5629 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5630 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5632 static XComposeStatus compose_status
;
5634 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5635 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5637 static int temp_index
;
5638 static short temp_buffer
[100];
5640 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5641 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5643 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5645 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5646 on a particular display. */
5648 struct x_display_info
*XTread_socket_fake_io_error
;
5650 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5651 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5652 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5653 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5655 static struct x_display_info
*next_noop_dpyinfo
;
5657 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5660 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5661 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5662 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5663 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5664 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5665 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5669 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5670 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5680 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5681 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5682 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5684 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5686 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5690 x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, event
)
5691 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
5694 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5695 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5696 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5699 struct frame
*f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5700 event
->xclient
.window
);
5702 return XFilterEvent (event
, f1
? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1
) : None
);
5707 static int current_count
;
5708 static int current_finish
;
5709 static struct input_event
*current_hold_quit
;
5711 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5712 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5713 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5714 static GdkFilterReturn
5715 event_handler_gdk (gxev
, ev
, data
)
5720 XEvent
*xev
= (XEvent
*) gxev
;
5722 if (current_count
>= 0)
5724 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
5726 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (xev
->xany
.display
);
5729 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5730 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5731 so we do it here. */
5732 if (xev
->type
== KeyPress
|| xev
->type
== KeyRelease
)
5733 if (dpyinfo
&& x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, xev
))
5734 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
5738 current_finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
5742 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, xev
, ¤t_finish
,
5747 current_finish
= x_dispatch_event (xev
, xev
->xany
.display
);
5749 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
|| current_finish
== X_EVENT_DROP
)
5750 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
5752 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE
;
5754 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5757 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5759 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5760 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5761 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5763 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5766 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, eventp
, finish
, hold_quit
)
5767 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
5770 struct input_event
*hold_quit
;
5773 struct input_event ie
;
5774 struct selection_input_event sie
;
5779 struct frame
*f
= NULL
;
5780 struct coding_system coding
;
5781 XEvent event
= *eventp
;
5783 *finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
5785 EVENT_INIT (inev
.ie
);
5786 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
;
5793 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5794 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
5795 && event
.xclient
.format
== 32)
5797 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5798 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
5800 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5801 could be the shell widget window
5802 if the frame has no title bar. */
5803 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5805 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5806 if (f
&& FRAME_XIC (f
))
5807 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f
));
5809 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5810 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5811 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5812 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5813 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5816 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5817 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5818 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5819 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5822 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5823 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5824 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5827 Display
*d
= event
.xclient
.display
;
5828 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5829 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5831 XSetInputFocus (d
, event
.xclient
.window
,
5832 /* The ICCCM says this is
5833 the only valid choice. */
5835 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1]);
5836 /* This is needed to detect the error
5837 if there is an error. */
5839 x_uncatch_errors ();
5841 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5846 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5847 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
5849 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5850 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5851 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5852 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5853 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5854 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5855 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5856 session manager and one for this. */
5858 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5861 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5862 event
.xclient
.window
);
5863 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5864 for a single Emacs process. */
5865 if (f
== SELECTED_FRAME ())
5866 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5867 event
.xclient
.window
,
5868 initial_argv
, initial_argc
);
5870 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5871 event
.xclient
.window
,
5877 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5878 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
5880 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5881 event
.xclient
.window
);
5883 goto OTHER
; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5885 inev
.ie
.kind
= DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT
;
5886 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
5893 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5894 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
5899 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5900 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
5903 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5905 new_x
= event
.xclient
.data
.s
[0];
5906 new_y
= event
.xclient
.data
.s
[1];
5910 f
->left_pos
= new_x
;
5917 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5918 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
)
5920 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5922 _XEditResCheckMessages (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, NULL
,
5926 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5928 if ((event
.xclient
.message_type
5929 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
)
5930 || (event
.xclient
.message_type
5931 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
))
5933 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5934 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5935 currently never do because we are interested in
5936 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5937 Pixmap pixmap
= (Pixmap
) event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1];
5938 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5941 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap
, f
);
5942 expose_frame (f
, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5946 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5947 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5948 we construct an input_event. */
5949 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5950 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
)
5952 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event
, &inev
.ie
);
5953 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
5956 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5958 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5961 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f
, &event
.xclient
, dpyinfo
, &inev
.ie
))
5962 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
5966 case SelectionNotify
:
5967 last_user_time
= event
.xselection
.time
;
5968 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5969 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselection
.requestor
))
5971 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5972 x_handle_selection_notify (&event
.xselection
);
5975 case SelectionClear
: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5976 last_user_time
= event
.xselectionclear
.time
;
5977 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5978 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselectionclear
.window
))
5980 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5982 XSelectionClearEvent
*eventp
= (XSelectionClearEvent
*) &event
;
5984 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT
;
5985 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->display
;
5986 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
5987 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
5988 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= Qnil
;
5992 case SelectionRequest
: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5993 last_user_time
= event
.xselectionrequest
.time
;
5994 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5995 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselectionrequest
.owner
))
5997 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5999 XSelectionRequestEvent
*eventp
6000 = (XSelectionRequestEvent
*) &event
;
6002 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT
;
6003 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->display
;
6004 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->requestor
;
6005 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6006 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->target
;
6007 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->property
;
6008 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6009 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= Qnil
;
6013 case PropertyNotify
:
6014 last_user_time
= event
.xproperty
.time
;
6015 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
6016 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
6017 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
6018 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
6019 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xproperty
.window
))
6023 x_handle_property_notify (&event
.xproperty
);
6026 case ReparentNotify
:
6027 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xreparent
.window
);
6031 f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
= event
.xreparent
.parent
;
6032 x_real_positions (f
, &x
, &y
);
6036 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6037 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
6038 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->net_supported_window
= 0;
6043 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xexpose
.window
);
6046 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
6049 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6050 x_clear_area (event
.xexpose
.display
,
6051 event
.xexpose
.window
,
6052 event
.xexpose
.x
, event
.xexpose
.y
,
6053 event
.xexpose
.width
, event
.xexpose
.height
,
6056 if (f
->async_visible
== 0)
6058 f
->async_visible
= 1;
6059 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
6060 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6061 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6065 event
.xexpose
.x
, event
.xexpose
.y
,
6066 event
.xexpose
.width
, event
.xexpose
.height
);
6070 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6071 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
6073 #if defined USE_LUCID
6074 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6075 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6076 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6079 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event
.xexpose
.window
);
6081 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget
);
6083 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6085 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6086 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6088 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6089 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xexpose
.display
,
6090 event
.xexpose
.window
);
6093 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar
, &event
);
6094 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6097 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6098 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6102 case GraphicsExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6103 source area was obscured or not
6105 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xgraphicsexpose
.drawable
);
6109 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.x
, event
.xgraphicsexpose
.y
,
6110 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.width
,
6111 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.height
);
6113 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6116 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6119 case NoExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6120 source area was completely
6125 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6126 if (event
.xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6129 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6132 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xunmap
.window
);
6133 if (f
) /* F may no longer exist if
6134 the frame was deleted. */
6136 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6137 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6138 display that won't ever be seen. */
6139 f
->async_visible
= 0;
6140 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6141 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6142 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6143 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6144 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6145 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6146 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6148 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
6150 inev
.ie
.kind
= ICONIFY_EVENT
;
6151 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6157 if (event
.xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6158 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6159 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6162 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6163 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6164 frame is visible. */
6165 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xmap
.window
);
6168 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6169 the frame's display structures.
6170 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6171 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6172 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6173 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6174 if (! f
->async_iconified
)
6175 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6177 f
->async_visible
= 1;
6178 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
6179 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6183 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
6184 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6186 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list
)
6187 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
6188 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6189 to update the frame titles
6190 in case this is the second frame. */
6191 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6197 last_user_time
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6198 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6200 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6201 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6202 if (popup_activated ())
6206 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xkey
.window
);
6208 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6209 mouse highlighting. */
6210 if (!dpyinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
&& INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight
)
6212 || !EQ (f
->tool_bar_window
, dpyinfo
->mouse_face_window
)))
6214 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo
);
6215 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 1;
6218 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6221 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6222 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6223 Widget widget
= XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo
->display
,
6225 if (widget
&& XmIsScrollBar (widget
))
6227 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
6228 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, XtWindow (widget
));
6231 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6235 KeySym keysym
, orig_keysym
;
6236 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6237 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6240 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6241 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6242 status_return even if the input is too long to
6243 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6244 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6245 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6246 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6247 unsigned char copy_buffer
[513];
6248 unsigned char *copy_bufptr
= copy_buffer
;
6249 int copy_bufsiz
= sizeof (copy_buffer
);
6251 Lisp_Object coding_system
= Qlatin_1
;
6255 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6256 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6257 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6259 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6263 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
6264 extra_keyboard_modifiers
);
6265 modifiers
= event
.xkey
.state
;
6267 /* This will have to go some day... */
6269 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6270 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6271 event
.xkey
.state
&= ~ControlMask
;
6272 event
.xkey
.state
&= ~(dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
6273 | dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
6274 | dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
6275 | dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
);
6277 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6278 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6279 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6280 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6281 not it is combined with Meta. */
6282 if (modifiers
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
6283 bzero (&compose_status
, sizeof (compose_status
));
6288 Status status_return
;
6290 coding_system
= Vlocale_coding_system
;
6291 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6292 &event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6293 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6295 if (status_return
== XBufferOverflow
)
6297 copy_bufsiz
= nbytes
+ 1;
6298 copy_bufptr
= (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz
);
6299 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6300 &event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6301 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6304 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6305 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6306 else if (status_return
== XLookupKeySym
)
6307 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6308 coding_system
= Qutf_8
;
6309 nbytes
= Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6310 &event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6311 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6313 if (status_return
== XBufferOverflow
)
6315 copy_bufsiz
= nbytes
+ 1;
6316 copy_bufptr
= (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz
);
6317 nbytes
= Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6320 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6326 if (status_return
== XLookupNone
)
6328 else if (status_return
== XLookupChars
)
6333 else if (status_return
!= XLookupKeySym
6334 && status_return
!= XLookupBoth
)
6338 nbytes
= XLookupString (&event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6339 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6342 nbytes
= XLookupString (&event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6343 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6347 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6348 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6349 if (compose_status
.chars_matched
> 0 && nbytes
== 0)
6352 bzero (&compose_status
, sizeof (compose_status
));
6353 orig_keysym
= keysym
;
6355 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6356 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6358 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
), modifiers
);
6359 inev
.ie
.timestamp
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6361 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6362 translations to characters. */
6363 if (keysym
>= 32 && keysym
< 128)
6364 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6366 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6367 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
6371 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6372 if ((keysym
>= 0x01000000 && keysym
<= 0x010033ff)
6373 || (keysym
>= 0x0100e000 && keysym
<= 0x0100ffff))
6375 int code
= keysym
& 0xFFFF, charset_id
, c1
, c2
;
6379 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6380 inev
.ie
.code
= code
;
6382 else if (code
< 0x100)
6385 charset_id
= CHARSET_8_BIT_CONTROL
;
6387 charset_id
= charset_latin_iso8859_1
;
6388 inev
.ie
.kind
= MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6389 inev
.ie
.code
= MAKE_CHAR (charset_id
, code
, 0);
6394 charset_id
= charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff
,
6396 else if (code
< 0xE000)
6397 charset_id
= charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff
,
6400 charset_id
= charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff
,
6402 c1
= (code
/ 96) + 32, c2
= (code
% 96) + 32;
6403 inev
.ie
.kind
= MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6404 inev
.ie
.code
= MAKE_CHAR (charset_id
, c1
, c2
);
6409 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6410 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table
)
6411 && (NATNUMP (c
= Fgethash (make_number (keysym
),
6415 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c
))
6416 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6417 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
6418 inev
.ie
.code
= XFASTINT (c
);
6422 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6423 if (((keysym
>= XK_BackSpace
&& keysym
<= XK_Escape
)
6424 || keysym
== XK_Delete
6425 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6426 || (keysym
>= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6427 && keysym
<= XK_ISO_Enter
)
6429 || IsCursorKey (keysym
) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6430 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6432 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6433 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6434 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6435 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6436 || ((unsigned) (keysym
) >= XK_Select
6437 && (unsigned)(keysym
) < XK_KP_Space
)
6439 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6440 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_circumflex
6442 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6443 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_grave
6445 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6446 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_tilde
6448 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6449 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_diaeresis
6451 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6452 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_macron
6454 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6455 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_degree
6457 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6458 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_acute
6460 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6461 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_cedilla
6463 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6464 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_breve
6466 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6467 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_ogonek
6469 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6470 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_caron
6472 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6473 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_doubleacute
6475 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6476 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_abovedot
6478 || IsKeypadKey (keysym
) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6479 || IsFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6480 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6481 || (orig_keysym
& (1 << 28))
6482 || (keysym
!= NoSymbol
&& nbytes
== 0))
6483 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym
)
6484 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6485 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6486 don't have real modifiers but
6487 should be treated similarly to
6488 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6489 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6490 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym
)
6492 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym
)
6493 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
)
6497 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym
);
6498 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6500 inev
.ie
.kind
= NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6501 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
6505 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6510 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6511 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6512 we used just above and the locale. */
6513 setup_coding_system (coding_system
, &coding
);
6514 coding
.src_multibyte
= 0;
6515 coding
.dst_multibyte
= 1;
6516 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6517 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6518 gives us composition information. */
6519 coding
.composing
= COMPOSITION_DISABLED
;
6523 /* Decode the input data. */
6527 for (i
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
++)
6529 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr
[i
]);
6532 require
= decoding_buffer_size (&coding
, nbytes
);
6533 p
= (unsigned char *) alloca (require
);
6534 coding
.mode
|= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK
;
6535 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6536 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6537 coding
.composing
= COMPOSITION_DISABLED
;
6538 decode_coding (&coding
, copy_bufptr
, p
, nbytes
, require
);
6539 nbytes
= coding
.produced
;
6540 nchars
= coding
.produced_char
;
6543 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6544 character events. */
6545 for (i
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
+= len
)
6547 if (nchars
== nbytes
)
6548 c
= copy_bufptr
[i
], len
= 1;
6550 c
= STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr
+ i
,
6552 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c
)
6553 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6554 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
6556 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
6560 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6561 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6564 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
; /* Already stored above. */
6566 if (keysym
== NoSymbol
)
6572 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6573 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6581 last_user_time
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6583 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6584 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6592 last_user_time
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6593 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6595 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xcrossing
.window
);
6597 if (f
&& x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
)
6598 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= event
.xmotion
.time
+ 200;
6601 if (event
.xcrossing
.focus
)
6603 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6604 if (f
&& (!(f
->auto_raise
)
6606 || (event
.xcrossing
.time
- enter_timestamp
) > 500))
6608 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, f
);
6609 enter_timestamp
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6612 else if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
6613 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, 0);
6616 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6617 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6618 if (f
&& !f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_p
)
6619 note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
.xmotion
);
6621 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6622 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6623 if (!f
&& last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
6624 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
.xmotion
);
6629 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6633 last_user_time
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6634 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6636 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xcrossing
.window
);
6639 if (f
== dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
6641 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6642 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6643 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo
);
6644 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
6647 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6648 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6649 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6650 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6651 if (any_help_event_p
)
6655 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6656 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
6657 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
.xmotion
);
6662 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6667 last_user_time
= event
.xmotion
.time
;
6668 previous_help_echo_string
= help_echo_string
;
6669 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
6671 if (dpyinfo
->grabbed
&& last_mouse_frame
6672 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
6673 f
= last_mouse_frame
;
6675 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xmotion
.window
);
6677 if (dpyinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
)
6679 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 0;
6680 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo
);
6686 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6687 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window
))
6691 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
,
6692 event
.xmotion
.x
, event
.xmotion
.y
,
6695 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6696 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6697 will be selected only when it is active. */
6698 if (WINDOWP (window
)
6699 && !EQ (window
, last_window
)
6700 && !EQ (window
, selected_window
)
6701 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6702 create event iff we don't leave the
6704 && (focus_follows_mouse
6705 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window
)->frame
,
6706 XWINDOW (selected_window
)->frame
))))
6708 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT
;
6709 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= window
;
6714 if (!note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
.xmotion
))
6715 help_echo_string
= previous_help_echo_string
;
6719 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6720 struct scroll_bar
*bar
6721 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xmotion
.display
,
6722 event
.xmotion
.window
);
6725 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar
, &event
);
6726 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6728 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6729 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6730 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo
);
6733 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6734 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6735 if (!NILP (help_echo_string
)
6736 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string
))
6741 case ConfigureNotify
:
6742 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xconfigure
.window
);
6745 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6747 xg_resize_widgets (f
, event
.xconfigure
.width
,
6748 event
.xconfigure
.height
);
6749 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6750 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6751 do this one, the right one will come later.
6752 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6753 need to reset it below. */
6755 = ((f
->want_fullscreen
& FULLSCREEN_WAIT
)
6756 && f
->new_text_cols
!= 0);
6757 int rows
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f
, event
.xconfigure
.height
);
6758 int columns
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f
, event
.xconfigure
.width
);
6763 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6764 is called by the code that handles resizing
6765 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6767 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6768 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6769 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6770 if (columns
!= FRAME_COLS (f
)
6771 || rows
!= FRAME_LINES (f
)
6772 || event
.xconfigure
.width
!= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
6773 || event
.xconfigure
.height
!= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
))
6775 change_frame_size (f
, rows
, columns
, 0, 1, 0);
6776 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6777 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
6779 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6782 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) = event
.xconfigure
.width
;
6783 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
) = event
.xconfigure
.height
;
6786 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6787 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6788 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)
6789 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)))
6792 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
6794 if (f
->want_fullscreen
& FULLSCREEN_WAIT
)
6795 f
->want_fullscreen
&= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT
|FULLSCREEN_BOTH
);
6799 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
))
6800 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
6803 if (f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
!= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
6805 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6806 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6807 f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
6808 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
6816 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6817 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6820 bzero (&compose_status
, sizeof (compose_status
));
6821 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= 0;
6822 last_user_time
= event
.xbutton
.time
;
6824 if (dpyinfo
->grabbed
6826 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
6827 f
= last_mouse_frame
;
6829 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xbutton
.window
);
6833 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6834 if (WINDOWP (f
->tool_bar_window
)
6835 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f
->tool_bar_window
)))
6838 int x
= event
.xbutton
.x
;
6839 int y
= event
.xbutton
.y
;
6841 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
, x
, y
, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6842 tool_bar_p
= EQ (window
, f
->tool_bar_window
);
6844 if (tool_bar_p
&& event
.xbutton
.button
< 4)
6846 handle_tool_bar_click (f
, x
, y
,
6847 event
.xbutton
.type
== ButtonPress
,
6848 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo
,
6849 event
.xbutton
.state
));
6854 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6855 if (! popup_activated ())
6858 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
)
6860 if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
6861 && (int)(event
.xbutton
.time
- ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
) > 0)
6863 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6864 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
.xbutton
, f
);
6866 if (event
.type
== ButtonRelease
)
6867 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6870 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
.xbutton
, f
);
6875 struct scroll_bar
*bar
6876 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xbutton
.display
,
6877 event
.xbutton
.window
);
6879 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6880 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6882 if (bar
&& event
.xbutton
.state
& ControlMask
)
6884 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6885 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6887 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6889 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6890 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6893 if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
)
6895 dpyinfo
->grabbed
|= (1 << event
.xbutton
.button
);
6896 last_mouse_frame
= f
;
6899 last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
6902 dpyinfo
->grabbed
&= ~(1 << event
.xbutton
.button
);
6904 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6905 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6906 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6910 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6911 f
= x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xbutton
.window
);
6912 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6913 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6914 Instead, save it away
6915 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6916 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6919 ! popup_activated ()
6922 f
&& event
.type
== ButtonPress
6923 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6924 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6925 && event
.xbutton
.x
>= 0
6926 && event
.xbutton
.x
< FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
6927 && event
.xbutton
.y
>= 0
6928 && event
.xbutton
.y
< f
->output_data
.x
->menubar_height
6929 && event
.xbutton
.same_screen
)
6931 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT
;
6932 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame
, f
);
6934 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6937 else if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
)
6939 last_mouse_press_frame
= Qnil
;
6943 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6944 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6945 else if (event
.type
== ButtonRelease
)
6947 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame
))
6949 f
= XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame
);
6950 if (f
->output_data
.x
)
6951 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT
;
6956 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6959 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6963 case CirculateNotify
:
6966 case CirculateRequest
:
6969 case VisibilityNotify
:
6973 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6975 switch (event
.xmapping
.request
)
6977 case MappingModifier
:
6978 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
6979 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6980 case MappingKeyboard
:
6981 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event
.xmapping
);
6987 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6989 if (*finish
!= X_EVENT_DROP
)
6990 XtDispatchEvent (&event
);
6992 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6997 if (inev
.ie
.kind
!= NO_EVENT
)
6999 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
7004 && !(hold_quit
&& hold_quit
->kind
!= NO_EVENT
))
7009 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
7015 any_help_event_p
= 1;
7016 gen_help_event (help_echo_string
, frame
, help_echo_window
,
7017 help_echo_object
, help_echo_pos
);
7021 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
7022 gen_help_event (Qnil
, frame
, Qnil
, Qnil
, 0);
7032 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7033 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7034 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7036 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7038 x_dispatch_event (event
, display
)
7042 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
7043 int finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
7045 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (display
);
7048 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, event
, &finish
, 0);
7054 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7055 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7056 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7058 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7059 thus pretending to be `read'.
7061 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7064 XTread_socket (terminal
, expected
, hold_quit
)
7065 struct terminal
*terminal
;
7067 struct input_event
*hold_quit
;
7071 int event_found
= 0;
7072 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
7074 if (interrupt_input_blocked
)
7076 interrupt_input_pending
= 1;
7080 interrupt_input_pending
= 0;
7083 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7084 input_signal_count
++;
7089 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7090 if (terminal
->id
== 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7092 struct input_event inev
;
7094 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7095 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7096 if (x_session_check_input (&inev
))
7098 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
, hold_quit
);
7105 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7106 if (terminal
->display_info
.x
== XTread_socket_fake_io_error
)
7108 XTread_socket_fake_io_error
= 0;
7109 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo
->display
);
7112 #if 0 /* This loop is a noop now. */
7113 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7114 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7115 for (dpyinfo
= x_display_list
; dpyinfo
; dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
)
7117 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7119 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7120 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7121 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7122 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7123 fcntl (dpyinfo
->connection
, F_SETFL
, 0);
7124 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7127 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7128 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7129 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7130 for X connections. */
7133 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo
->connection
, F_GETFL
, 0) & O_NDELAY
))
7135 extern int read_alarm_should_throw
;
7136 read_alarm_should_throw
= 1;
7137 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo
->display
, &event
);
7138 read_alarm_should_throw
= 0;
7140 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7147 while (XPending (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
))
7151 XNextEvent (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
, &event
);
7154 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7155 if (x_filter_event (terminal
->display_info
.x
, &event
))
7160 count
+= handle_one_xevent (terminal
->display_info
.x
,
7161 &event
, &finish
, hold_quit
);
7163 if (finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7169 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7170 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7171 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7172 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7174 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7175 from all displays. */
7177 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7179 current_count
= count
;
7180 current_hold_quit
= hold_quit
;
7182 gtk_main_iteration ();
7184 count
= current_count
;
7186 current_hold_quit
= 0;
7188 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7191 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7195 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7196 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7199 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7200 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7201 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7203 if (x_noop_count
>= 100)
7207 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== 0)
7208 next_noop_dpyinfo
= x_display_list
;
7210 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo
->display
);
7212 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7213 next_noop_dpyinfo
= next_noop_dpyinfo
->next
;
7217 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7219 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7220 if (pending_autoraise_frame
)
7222 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame
);
7223 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
7235 /***********************************************************************
7237 ***********************************************************************/
7239 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7240 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7242 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7243 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7244 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7247 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, area
, gc
)
7249 struct glyph_row
*row
;
7253 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7254 XRectangle clip_rect
;
7255 int window_x
, window_y
, window_width
;
7257 window_box (w
, area
, &window_x
, &window_y
, &window_width
, 0);
7259 clip_rect
.x
= window_x
;
7260 clip_rect
.y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, row
->y
));
7261 clip_rect
.y
= max (clip_rect
.y
, window_y
);
7262 clip_rect
.width
= window_width
;
7263 clip_rect
.height
= row
->visible_height
;
7265 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
, 0, 0, &clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
7269 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7272 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w
, row
)
7274 struct glyph_row
*row
;
7276 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7277 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
7278 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7281 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7284 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7285 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7286 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7287 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7290 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7291 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &x
, &y
, &h
);
7292 wd
= w
->phys_cursor_width
;
7294 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7295 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7296 xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7297 if (dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
)
7298 XChangeGC (dpy
, dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7300 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7301 GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7302 gc
= dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7304 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7305 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7306 XDrawRectangle (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
, x
, y
, wd
, h
- 1);
7307 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7311 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7313 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7314 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7315 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7319 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, row
, width
, kind
)
7321 struct glyph_row
*row
;
7323 enum text_cursor_kinds kind
;
7325 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
7326 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7328 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7329 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7331 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7332 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7335 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7336 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7337 the bar might not be in the window. */
7338 if (cursor_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
)
7340 struct glyph_row
*row
;
7341 row
= MATRIX_ROW (w
->current_matrix
, w
->phys_cursor
.vpos
);
7342 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, row
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
7346 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7347 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
7348 GC gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7349 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
7350 struct face
*face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, cursor_glyph
->face_id
);
7353 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7354 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7355 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7356 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7357 that the glyph is legible. */
7358 if (face
->background
== f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
7359 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= face
->foreground
;
7361 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7362 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= 0;
7365 XChangeGC (dpy
, gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
7368 gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
7369 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
= gc
;
7373 width
= FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f
);
7374 width
= min (cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
, width
);
7376 w
->phys_cursor_width
= width
;
7377 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7379 if (kind
== BAR_CURSOR
)
7380 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
,
7381 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
),
7382 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
),
7383 width
, row
->height
);
7385 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
,
7386 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
),
7387 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
+
7388 row
->height
- width
),
7389 cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
,
7392 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7397 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7400 x_define_frame_cursor (f
, cursor
)
7404 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), cursor
);
7408 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7411 x_clear_frame_area (f
, x
, y
, width
, height
)
7413 int x
, y
, width
, height
;
7415 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7416 x
, y
, width
, height
, False
);
7420 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7423 x_draw_window_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, x
, y
, cursor_type
, cursor_width
, on_p
, active_p
)
7425 struct glyph_row
*glyph_row
;
7427 int cursor_type
, cursor_width
;
7430 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7434 w
->phys_cursor_type
= cursor_type
;
7435 w
->phys_cursor_on_p
= 1;
7437 if (glyph_row
->exact_window_width_line_p
7438 && w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
>= glyph_row
->used
[TEXT_AREA
])
7440 glyph_row
->cursor_in_fringe_p
= 1;
7441 draw_fringe_bitmap (w
, glyph_row
, 0);
7444 switch (cursor_type
)
7446 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR
:
7447 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w
, glyph_row
);
7450 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR
:
7451 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, glyph_row
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
7455 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, BAR_CURSOR
);
7459 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, HBAR_CURSOR
);
7463 w
->phys_cursor_width
= 0;
7471 if (w
== XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
))
7472 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
))
7473 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, x
, y
);
7478 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
7485 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7488 x_bitmap_icon (f
, file
)
7494 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
7497 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7498 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
7499 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
7500 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
7505 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7506 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7507 if (xg_set_icon (f
, file
))
7509 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7510 bitmap_id
= x_create_bitmap_from_file (f
, file
);
7511 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, bitmap_id
);
7515 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7516 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
< 0)
7520 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7522 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
))
7525 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
);
7527 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
7528 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7529 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7531 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7534 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_data (f
, gnu_xbm_bits
,
7535 gnu_xbm_width
, gnu_xbm_height
);
7539 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
7540 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
7544 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7545 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7546 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7547 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7548 x_reference_bitmap (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
7550 bitmap_id
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
;
7553 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, bitmap_id
);
7554 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= bitmap_id
;
7560 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7561 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7564 x_text_icon (f
, icon_name
)
7568 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
7573 text
.value
= (unsigned char *) icon_name
;
7574 text
.encoding
= XA_STRING
;
7576 text
.nitems
= strlen (icon_name
);
7577 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &text
);
7580 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
7581 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
7582 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
7583 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, 0);
7588 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7590 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7591 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7593 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7594 be called from a signal handler.
7597 struct x_error_message_stack
{
7598 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
7600 struct x_error_message_stack
*prev
;
7602 static struct x_error_message_stack
*x_error_message
;
7604 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7605 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7606 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7609 x_error_catcher (display
, error
)
7613 XGetErrorText (display
, error
->error_code
,
7614 x_error_message
->string
,
7615 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
7618 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7619 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7622 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7623 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7624 stored in *x_error_message.
7626 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7627 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7629 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7631 void x_check_errors ();
7634 x_catch_errors (dpy
)
7637 struct x_error_message_stack
*data
= xmalloc (sizeof (*data
));
7639 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7643 data
->string
[0] = 0;
7644 data
->prev
= x_error_message
;
7645 x_error_message
= data
;
7648 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7649 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7654 struct x_error_message_stack
*tmp
;
7658 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7659 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7660 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message
->dpy
) != 0)
7661 XSync (x_error_message
->dpy
, False
);
7663 tmp
= x_error_message
;
7664 x_error_message
= x_error_message
->prev
;
7669 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7670 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7671 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7674 x_check_errors (dpy
, format
)
7678 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7681 if (x_error_message
->string
[0])
7683 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
7684 bcopy (x_error_message
->string
, string
, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
7685 x_uncatch_errors ();
7686 error (format
, string
);
7690 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7691 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7694 x_had_errors_p (dpy
)
7697 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7700 return x_error_message
->string
[0] != 0;
7703 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7706 x_clear_errors (dpy
)
7709 x_error_message
->string
[0] = 0;
7712 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7713 * idea. --lorentey */
7714 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7717 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7719 while (x_error_message
)
7720 x_uncatch_errors ();
7724 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7727 x_catching_errors ()
7729 return x_error_message
!= 0;
7733 static unsigned int x_wire_count
;
7736 fprintf (stderr
, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count
);
7741 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7742 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7743 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7744 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7745 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7748 x_connection_signal (signalnum
) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7749 int signalnum
; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7752 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7753 must reestablish each time */
7754 signal (signalnum
, x_connection_signal
);
7759 /************************************************************************
7761 ************************************************************************/
7763 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7765 static char *error_msg
;
7767 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7768 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7769 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7772 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7774 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n", error_msg
);
7778 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7779 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7782 x_connection_closed (dpy
, error_message
)
7784 char *error_message
;
7786 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
7787 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
7788 int index
= SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7790 error_msg
= (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message
) + 1);
7791 strcpy (error_msg
, error_message
);
7792 handling_signal
= 0;
7794 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7795 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7796 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7797 the original message here. */
7798 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
7800 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7801 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay
, Qt
);
7805 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7807 dpyinfo
->reference_count
++;
7808 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
++;
7811 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7812 that are on the dead display. */
7813 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7815 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame
;
7817 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame
))));
7818 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
7819 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
))
7820 && ! EQ (frame
, minibuf_frame
)
7821 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
7822 Fdelete_frame (frame
, Qt
);
7825 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7826 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7827 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7828 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7829 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
7830 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
7832 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7833 trying to find a replacement. */
7834 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame
))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame
= Qt
;
7835 Fdelete_frame (frame
, Qt
);
7838 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7839 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7840 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7842 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7843 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7844 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7846 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7847 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7849 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7850 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7851 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7853 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7854 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7855 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7858 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook
) P_ ((void));
7859 fatal_error_signal_hook
= x_fatal_error_signal
;
7860 XtCloseDisplay (dpy
);
7861 fatal_error_signal_hook
= NULL
;
7867 xg_display_close (dpyinfo
->display
);
7872 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7873 dpyinfo
->display
= 0;
7875 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
7876 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
--;
7877 if (dpyinfo
->reference_count
!= 0)
7878 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7881 x_delete_display (dpyinfo
);
7884 x_uncatch_errors ();
7886 if (terminal_list
== 0)
7888 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n", error_msg
);
7889 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil
);
7893 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7895 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO
));
7897 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM
));
7898 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT
;
7900 unbind_to (index
, Qnil
);
7901 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7902 /* FIXME: This is an asynchronous interrupt w.r.t elisp, so signalling an
7903 error might not be the best thing to do. I'd vote for creating an
7904 elisp event and stuffing it in the queue so people can bind to it via
7905 the global map. --Stef */
7906 error ("%s", error_msg
);
7909 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7910 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7911 static void x_error_quitter
P_ ((Display
*, XErrorEvent
*));
7913 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7914 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7917 x_error_handler (display
, error
)
7921 if (x_error_message
)
7922 x_error_catcher (display
, error
);
7924 x_error_quitter (display
, error
);
7928 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7929 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7930 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7932 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7934 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7935 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7940 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7946 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7947 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7949 static void NO_INLINE
7950 x_error_quitter (display
, error
)
7954 char buf
[256], buf1
[356];
7956 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7957 or colors that are not defined. */
7959 if (error
->error_code
== BadName
)
7962 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7963 original error handler. */
7965 XGetErrorText (display
, error
->error_code
, buf
, sizeof (buf
));
7966 sprintf (buf1
, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7967 buf
, error
->request_code
);
7968 x_connection_closed (display
, buf1
);
7972 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7973 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7974 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7977 x_io_error_quitter (display
)
7982 sprintf (buf
, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display
));
7983 x_connection_closed (display
, buf
);
7987 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7989 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7990 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7991 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7992 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7995 x_new_font (f
, fontname
)
7997 register char *fontname
;
7999 struct font_info
*fontp
8000 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f
, 0, fontname
, -1);
8005 FRAME_FONT (f
) = (XFontStruct
*) (fontp
->font
);
8006 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f
) = fontp
->baseline_offset
;
8007 FRAME_FONTSET (f
) = -1;
8009 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) = fontp
->average_width
;
8010 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f
) = fontp
->space_width
;
8011 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f
));
8013 compute_fringe_widths (f
, 1);
8015 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8016 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) > 0)
8018 int wid
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
8019 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
)
8020 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) + wid
-1) / wid
;
8024 int wid
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
8025 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) = (14 + wid
- 1) / wid
;
8028 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
8029 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) != 0)
8031 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
8032 FRAME_FONT (f
)->fid
);
8033 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->reverse_gc
,
8034 FRAME_FONT (f
)->fid
);
8035 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_gc
,
8036 FRAME_FONT (f
)->fid
);
8038 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8039 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8040 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8041 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
8042 x_set_window_size (f
, 0, FRAME_COLS (f
), FRAME_LINES (f
));
8045 return build_string (fontp
->full_name
);
8048 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
8049 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
8050 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
8051 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
8054 x_new_fontset (f
, fontsetname
)
8058 int fontset
= fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname
), 0);
8064 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f
) == fontset
)
8065 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
8067 return fontset_name (fontset
);
8069 result
= x_new_font (f
, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset
))));
8071 if (!STRINGP (result
))
8072 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
8075 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
8076 FRAME_FONTSET (f
) = fontset
;
8080 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & (XIMPreeditPosition
| XIMStatusArea
)))
8081 xic_set_xfontset (f
, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset
)));
8084 return build_string (fontsetname
);
8088 /***********************************************************************
8090 ***********************************************************************/
8096 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8097 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8098 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8101 xim_destroy_callback (xim
, client_data
, call_data
)
8103 XPointer client_data
;
8106 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) client_data
;
8107 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
8111 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8112 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8114 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
8115 if (FRAME_X_P (f
) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
)
8117 FRAME_XIC (f
) = NULL
;
8118 xic_free_xfontset (f
);
8122 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8123 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8124 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8128 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8131 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8132 extern char *XSetIMValues
P_ ((XIM
, ...));
8135 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8136 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8139 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, resource_name
)
8140 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
8141 char *resource_name
;
8148 xim
= XOpenIM (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, resource_name
,
8155 XIMCallback destroy
;
8158 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8159 XGetIMValues (xim
, XNQueryInputStyle
, &dpyinfo
->xim_styles
, NULL
);
8162 destroy
.callback
= xim_destroy_callback
;
8163 destroy
.client_data
= (XPointer
)dpyinfo
;
8164 XSetIMValues (xim
, XNDestroyCallback
, &destroy
, NULL
);
8170 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8171 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8175 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8179 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
8180 char *resource_name
;
8183 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8184 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8185 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8186 when the callback was registered. */
8189 xim_instantiate_callback (display
, client_data
, call_data
)
8191 XPointer client_data
;
8194 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) client_data
;
8195 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= xim_inst
->dpyinfo
;
8197 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8201 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, xim_inst
->resource_name
);
8203 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8204 as they have no XIC. */
8205 if (dpyinfo
->xim
&& dpyinfo
->reference_count
> 0)
8207 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
8210 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8212 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
8215 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == xim_inst
->dpyinfo
)
8216 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) == NULL
)
8218 create_frame_xic (f
);
8219 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
)
8220 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
8221 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
)
8223 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
);
8224 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, w
->cursor
.x
, w
->cursor
.y
);
8233 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8236 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8237 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8238 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8239 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8242 xim_initialize (dpyinfo
, resource_name
)
8243 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
8244 char *resource_name
;
8249 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8250 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
;
8253 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8254 xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t
));
8255 xim_inst
->dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
;
8256 len
= strlen (resource_name
);
8257 xim_inst
->resource_name
= (char *) xmalloc (len
+ 1);
8258 bcopy (resource_name
, xim_inst
->resource_name
, len
+ 1);
8259 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
,
8260 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
,
8261 xim_instantiate_callback
,
8262 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8263 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8264 least, hence the configure test. */
8265 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6
) xim_inst
);
8266 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8267 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8268 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
8269 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8273 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8274 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8278 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8281 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo
)
8282 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
8287 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8288 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8289 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
,
8291 xim_instantiate_callback
, NULL
);
8292 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8293 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8294 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8295 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8296 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8298 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8301 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8305 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8306 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8309 x_calc_absolute_position (f
)
8312 int flags
= f
->size_hint_flags
;
8314 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8315 is already for the top-left corner. */
8316 if (! ((flags
& XNegative
) || (flags
& YNegative
)))
8319 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8320 position that fits on the screen. */
8321 if (flags
& XNegative
)
8322 f
->left_pos
= (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->width
8323 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) + f
->left_pos
);
8326 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8328 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8329 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8330 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8332 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8333 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8334 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8335 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8338 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8339 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8341 XtVaGetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->column_widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
8344 if (flags
& YNegative
)
8345 f
->top_pos
= (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->height
- height
+ f
->top_pos
);
8348 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8349 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8350 so the flags should correspond. */
8351 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8354 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8355 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8356 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8357 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8358 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8361 x_set_offset (f
, xoff
, yoff
, change_gravity
)
8363 register int xoff
, yoff
;
8366 int modified_top
, modified_left
;
8368 if (change_gravity
!= 0)
8370 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->left_before_move
= f
->left_pos
;
8371 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->top_before_move
= f
->top_pos
;
8375 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8377 f
->size_hint_flags
|= XNegative
;
8379 f
->size_hint_flags
|= YNegative
;
8380 f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8382 x_calc_absolute_position (f
);
8385 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
8387 modified_left
= f
->left_pos
;
8388 modified_top
= f
->top_pos
;
8390 if (change_gravity
!= 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
)
8392 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8393 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8394 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8395 modified_left
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8396 modified_top
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8399 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8400 modified_left
, modified_top
);
8402 x_sync_with_move (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
,
8403 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8406 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8407 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8408 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8409 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8412 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8413 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8414 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8416 if (change_gravity
!= 0 &&
8417 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8418 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
8419 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
== 0
8420 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
== 0))))
8421 x_check_expected_move (f
, modified_left
, modified_top
);
8426 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8427 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8428 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8429 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8430 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec. */
8433 wm_supports (f
, atomname
)
8435 const char *atomname
;
8438 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
8439 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
8441 Window wmcheck_window
;
8442 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8443 Window target_window
= dpyinfo
->root_window
;
8444 long max_len
= 65536;
8445 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8446 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
8447 Atom target_type
= XA_WINDOW
;
8452 prop_atom
= XInternAtom (dpy
, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False
);
8454 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
8455 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
8456 prop_atom
, 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8457 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8458 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8460 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_WINDOW
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8462 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8463 x_uncatch_errors ();
8468 wmcheck_window
= *(Window
*) tmp_data
;
8471 /* Check if window exists. */
8472 XSelectInput (dpy
, wmcheck_window
, StructureNotifyMask
);
8474 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8476 x_uncatch_errors ();
8481 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
!= wmcheck_window
)
8483 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8484 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
!= NULL
)
8485 XFree (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
);
8486 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
8487 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
8488 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
8490 target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
8491 prop_atom
= XInternAtom (dpy
, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False
);
8493 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
8494 prop_atom
, 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8495 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8496 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8498 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_ATOM
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8500 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8501 x_uncatch_errors ();
8506 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= (Atom
*)tmp_data
;
8507 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= actual_size
;
8508 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= wmcheck_window
;
8512 want_atom
= XInternAtom (dpy
, atomname
, False
);
8514 for (i
= 0; rc
== 0 && i
< dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
; ++i
)
8515 rc
= dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
[i
] == want_atom
;
8517 x_uncatch_errors ();
8523 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8526 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f
)
8529 int have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8531 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8532 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8534 have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8539 const char *atom
= "_NET_WM_STATE";
8540 const char *fs
= "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8541 const char *fw
= "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8542 const char *fh
= "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8543 const char *what
= NULL
;
8545 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8547 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8549 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
8551 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8554 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8557 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8562 if (what
!= NULL
&& !wm_supports (f
, what
)) return 0;
8565 Fx_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8566 make_unibyte_string (atom
, strlen (atom
)),
8568 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8570 (make_unibyte_string (fs
,
8573 Fx_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8574 make_unibyte_string (atom
, strlen (atom
)),
8576 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8578 (make_unibyte_string (fh
,
8581 Fx_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8582 make_unibyte_string (atom
, strlen (atom
)),
8584 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8586 (make_unibyte_string (fw
,
8589 f
->want_fullscreen
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8591 Fx_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8592 make_unibyte_string (atom
, strlen (atom
)),
8594 Fcons (make_number (1), /* Add */
8596 (make_unibyte_string (what
,
8601 return have_net_atom
;
8605 XTfullscreen_hook (f
)
8608 if (f
->async_visible
)
8611 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f
);
8618 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8619 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8621 x_check_fullscreen (f
)
8624 if (f
->want_fullscreen
& FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
8626 int width
, height
, ign
;
8628 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f
))
8631 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
8633 x_fullscreen_adjust (f
, &width
, &height
, &ign
, &ign
);
8635 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8636 when setting WM manager hints.
8637 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8638 x_check_expected_move. */
8639 if (FRAME_COLS (f
) != width
|| FRAME_LINES (f
) != height
)
8641 change_frame_size (f
, height
, width
, 0, 1, 0);
8642 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
8643 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
8645 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8646 f
->want_fullscreen
|= FULLSCREEN_WAIT
;
8651 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8652 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8653 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8654 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8655 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8656 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8657 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8660 x_check_expected_move (f
, expected_left
, expected_top
)
8665 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
8667 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8668 window manager window around the frame. */
8670 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
8672 if (current_left
!= expected_left
|| current_top
!= expected_top
)
8674 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8679 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_A
;
8680 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
= expected_left
- current_left
;
8681 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
= expected_top
- current_top
;
8683 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8685 adjusted_left
= expected_left
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8686 adjusted_top
= expected_top
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8688 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8689 adjusted_left
, adjusted_top
);
8691 x_sync_with_move (f
, expected_left
, expected_top
, 0);
8694 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8695 frame's position. */
8697 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_B
;
8701 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8702 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8703 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8704 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8705 of an exact comparison. */
8708 x_sync_with_move (f
, left
, top
, fuzzy
)
8710 int left
, top
, fuzzy
;
8714 while (count
++ < 50)
8716 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
8718 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8719 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8722 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
8723 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
8727 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8730 if (eabs (current_left
- left
) <= 10
8731 && eabs (current_top
- top
) <= 40)
8734 else if (current_left
== left
&& current_top
== top
)
8738 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8739 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8741 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil
, NULL
, 0);
8745 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8746 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8747 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8748 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8751 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
)
8756 int pixelwidth
, pixelheight
;
8758 check_frame_size (f
, &rows
, &cols
);
8759 f
->scroll_bar_actual_width
8760 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
)
8762 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) > 0
8763 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
)
8764 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
)));
8766 compute_fringe_widths (f
, 0);
8768 pixelwidth
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, cols
);
8769 pixelheight
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, rows
);
8771 f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8772 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
8774 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
8775 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8776 pixelwidth
, pixelheight
);
8778 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8779 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8780 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8781 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8783 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8784 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8785 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8786 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8787 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8789 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8791 change_frame_size (f
, rows
, cols
, 0, 1, 0);
8792 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) = pixelwidth
;
8793 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
) = pixelheight
;
8795 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8796 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8797 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8798 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8799 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
8801 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8805 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8806 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8807 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8808 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8811 x_set_window_size (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
)
8819 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
8820 xg_frame_set_char_size (f
, cols
, rows
);
8822 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8825 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
!= NULL
)
8827 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8828 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8829 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8830 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8831 int xpos
= f
->output_data
.x
->widget
->core
.x
;
8832 int ypos
= f
->output_data
.x
->widget
->core
.y
;
8833 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, cols
, rows
);
8834 f
->output_data
.x
->widget
->core
.x
= xpos
;
8835 f
->output_data
.x
->widget
->core
.y
= ypos
;
8838 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8840 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8842 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8844 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8846 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8847 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f
->root_window
));
8849 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8850 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8851 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8852 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8853 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
8858 /* Mouse warping. */
8861 x_set_mouse_position (f
, x
, y
)
8867 pix_x
= FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f
, x
) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) / 2;
8868 pix_y
= FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f
, y
) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) / 2;
8870 if (pix_x
< 0) pix_x
= 0;
8871 if (pix_x
> FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)) pix_x
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
8873 if (pix_y
< 0) pix_y
= 0;
8874 if (pix_y
> FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
)) pix_y
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8878 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8879 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
8883 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8886 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f
, pix_x
, pix_y
)
8892 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8893 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
8897 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8900 x_focus_on_frame (f
)
8903 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8907 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8908 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8909 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8910 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8911 RevertToPointerRoot
, CurrentTime
);
8920 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8921 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_focus_frame
== f
)
8922 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), PointerRoot
,
8923 RevertToPointerRoot
, CurrentTime
);
8927 /* Raise frame F. */
8934 if (f
->async_visible
)
8935 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
8937 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8941 /* Lower frame F. */
8947 if (f
->async_visible
)
8950 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
8951 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8956 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8959 x_ewmh_activate_frame (f
)
8962 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8963 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec */
8965 const char *atom
= "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
8966 if (f
->async_visible
&& wm_supports (f
, atom
))
8969 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8970 Fx_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8971 make_unibyte_string (atom
, strlen (atom
)),
8973 Fcons (make_number (1),
8974 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time
),
8980 XTframe_raise_lower (f
, raise_flag
)
8990 /* Change of visibility. */
8992 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8993 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8994 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8995 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8996 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8997 finishes with it. */
9000 x_make_frame_visible (f
)
9004 int original_top
, original_left
;
9005 int retry_count
= 2;
9011 type
= x_icon_type (f
);
9013 x_bitmap_icon (f
, type
);
9015 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9017 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9018 call x_set_offset a second time
9019 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9020 before the window gets really visible. */
9021 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9022 && ! f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
)
9023 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9025 f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
= 1;
9027 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9028 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, NormalState
);
9029 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9030 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9031 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9032 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9034 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9035 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9037 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9038 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9039 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9040 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
9041 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
9042 to come back ok without this. */
9043 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
))
9044 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9048 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9050 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9051 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9052 so that incoming events are handled. */
9056 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9057 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9058 will set it when they are handled. */
9059 int previously_visible
= f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
;
9061 original_left
= f
->left_pos
;
9062 original_top
= f
->top_pos
;
9064 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9067 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9069 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9070 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9071 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9072 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9074 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9075 because the window manager may choose the position
9076 and we don't want to override it. */
9078 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9079 && f
->win_gravity
== NorthWestGravity
9080 && previously_visible
)
9084 unsigned int width
, height
, border
, depth
;
9088 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9089 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9090 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9091 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9092 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9093 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9094 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9095 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9096 &rootw
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
, &border
, &depth
);
9098 if (original_left
!= x
|| original_top
!= y
)
9099 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9100 original_left
, original_top
);
9105 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9107 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9108 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9109 MapNotify at all.. */
9110 for (count
= input_signal_count
+ 10;
9111 input_signal_count
< count
&& !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
);)
9113 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9116 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9117 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9118 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9119 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9120 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9122 if (input_polling_used ())
9124 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9125 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9126 handler reset it. */
9127 extern void poll_for_input_1
P_ ((void));
9128 int old_poll_suppress_count
= poll_suppress_count
;
9129 poll_suppress_count
= 1;
9130 poll_for_input_1 ();
9131 poll_suppress_count
= old_poll_suppress_count
;
9134 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9135 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f
);
9140 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9144 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9145 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9146 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9147 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9149 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && --retry_count
> 0)
9154 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9156 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9159 x_make_frame_invisible (f
)
9164 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9165 window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9167 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9168 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9169 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9171 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
9172 if (! f
->async_visible
&& ! f
->async_iconified
)
9178 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9179 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9180 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9181 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9182 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9183 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 1);
9186 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9187 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9192 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
,
9193 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))))
9195 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL
;
9196 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9200 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9201 just by the event that we get from the server.
9202 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9203 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9204 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9206 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
) = 0;
9207 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9208 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
9215 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9224 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9225 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9226 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9228 if (f
->async_iconified
)
9233 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f
);
9235 type
= x_icon_type (f
);
9237 x_bitmap_icon (f
, type
);
9240 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9242 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9243 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9245 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9248 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9249 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9255 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9257 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9259 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9260 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9261 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9262 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9263 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9264 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9265 so we have to record it here. */
9268 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9269 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9274 result
= XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9275 XtWindow (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
),
9276 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)));
9280 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9282 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9283 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9287 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9289 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9291 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9292 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9293 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
9294 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9296 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9297 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9299 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9300 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9304 message
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
9305 message
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
9306 message
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_wm_change_state
;
9307 message
.xclient
.format
= 32;
9308 message
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = IconicState
;
9310 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9311 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)),
9313 SubstructureRedirectMask
| SubstructureNotifyMask
,
9316 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL
;
9317 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9321 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9323 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9325 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9327 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9328 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9331 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9332 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9334 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9336 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9340 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9343 x_free_frame_resources (f
)
9346 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9348 struct scroll_bar
*b
;
9352 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9353 commands to the X server. */
9354 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
9356 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
)
9357 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
);
9359 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9360 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9361 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9362 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9363 toolkit scroll bars. */
9364 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); !NILP (bar
); bar
= b
->next
)
9366 b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
9367 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
9376 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9377 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
9379 XtDestroyWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9380 f
->output_data
.x
->widget
= NULL
;
9382 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9383 we are using a toolkit. */
9384 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
9385 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9387 free_frame_menubar (f
);
9388 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9391 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9392 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9393 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9395 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9396 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9397 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
) = 0;
9399 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9401 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
9402 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9403 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9405 unload_color (f
, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
9406 unload_color (f
, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
9407 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
);
9408 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
);
9409 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
9410 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->mouse_pixel
);
9412 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
!= -1)
9413 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
);
9414 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
9415 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
9416 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9417 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9418 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
9419 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
);
9420 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
9421 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
);
9422 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9423 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.allocated_p
)
9424 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.pixel
);
9425 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.allocated_p
)
9426 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.pixel
);
9428 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f
))
9429 free_frame_faces (f
);
9432 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9435 if (f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
)
9436 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
);
9438 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
);
9439 f
->output_data
.x
= NULL
;
9441 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
9442 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
9443 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
)
9444 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
9445 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
9446 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9448 if (f
== dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
9450 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
9451 = dpyinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
9452 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
9453 = dpyinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
9454 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
9455 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
9456 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
9463 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9466 x_destroy_window (f
)
9469 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9471 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9472 commands to the X server. */
9473 if (dpyinfo
->display
!= 0)
9474 x_free_frame_resources (f
);
9476 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
9480 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9482 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9483 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9484 that the window now has.
9485 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9486 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9487 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9491 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, flags
, user_position
)
9496 XSizeHints size_hints
;
9498 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9501 Dimension widget_width
, widget_height
;
9504 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9506 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9507 size_hints
.flags
= PResizeInc
| PMinSize
/* | PMaxSize */;
9509 size_hints
.x
= f
->left_pos
;
9510 size_hints
.y
= f
->top_pos
;
9512 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9513 XtSetArg (al
[ac
], XtNwidth
, &widget_width
); ac
++;
9514 XtSetArg (al
[ac
], XtNheight
, &widget_height
); ac
++;
9515 XtGetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, ac
);
9516 size_hints
.height
= widget_height
;
9517 size_hints
.width
= widget_width
;
9518 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9519 size_hints
.height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
9520 size_hints
.width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
9521 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9523 size_hints
.width_inc
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
9524 size_hints
.height_inc
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
9525 size_hints
.max_width
9526 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->width
- FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
9527 size_hints
.max_height
9528 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->height
- FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
9530 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9532 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9533 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9534 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9536 int base_width
, base_height
;
9537 int min_rows
= 0, min_cols
= 0;
9539 base_width
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
9540 base_height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
9542 check_frame_size (f
, &min_rows
, &min_cols
);
9544 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9545 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9546 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9547 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9548 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9550 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9551 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9552 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9554 size_hints
.flags
|= PBaseSize
;
9555 size_hints
.base_width
= base_width
;
9556 size_hints
.base_height
= base_height
;
9557 size_hints
.min_width
= base_width
+ min_cols
* size_hints
.width_inc
;
9558 size_hints
.min_height
= base_height
+ min_rows
* size_hints
.height_inc
;
9561 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9564 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
9567 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9570 XSizeHints hints
; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9571 long supplied_return
;
9574 value
= XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &hints
,
9577 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9578 size_hints
.base_height
= hints
.base_height
;
9579 size_hints
.base_width
= hints
.base_width
;
9580 size_hints
.min_height
= hints
.min_height
;
9581 size_hints
.min_width
= hints
.min_width
;
9585 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
9590 if (hints
.flags
& PSize
)
9591 size_hints
.flags
|= PSize
;
9592 if (hints
.flags
& PPosition
)
9593 size_hints
.flags
|= PPosition
;
9594 if (hints
.flags
& USPosition
)
9595 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
9596 if (hints
.flags
& USSize
)
9597 size_hints
.flags
|= USSize
;
9601 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9606 size_hints
.win_gravity
= f
->win_gravity
;
9607 size_hints
.flags
|= PWinGravity
;
9611 size_hints
.flags
&= ~ PPosition
;
9612 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
9614 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9616 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &size_hints
);
9618 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9620 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9623 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, state
)
9627 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9630 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNinitialState
, state
);
9631 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9632 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9633 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
9635 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= StateHint
;
9636 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.initial_state
= state
;
9638 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9639 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9643 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, pixmap_id
)
9647 Pixmap icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
;
9649 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9650 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9655 icon_pixmap
= x_bitmap_pixmap (f
, pixmap_id
);
9656 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_pixmap
= icon_pixmap
;
9657 icon_mask
= x_bitmap_mask (f
, pixmap_id
);
9658 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_mask
= icon_mask
;
9662 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9663 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9664 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9665 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9666 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9667 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9668 best to explicitly give up. */
9670 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_pixmap
= None
;
9671 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_mask
= None
;
9680 xg_set_frame_icon (f
, icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
);
9684 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9688 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconPixmap
, icon_pixmap
);
9689 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9690 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconMask
, icon_mask
);
9691 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9694 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9696 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= (IconPixmapHint
| IconMaskHint
);
9697 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9699 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9703 x_wm_set_icon_position (f
, icon_x
, icon_y
)
9707 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9709 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= IconPositionHint
;
9710 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_x
= icon_x
;
9711 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_y
= icon_y
;
9713 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9717 /***********************************************************************
9719 ***********************************************************************/
9721 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9724 x_get_font_info (f
, font_idx
)
9728 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f
) + font_idx
);
9732 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9734 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9737 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9739 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9740 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9741 on how many fonts to match. */
9744 x_list_fonts (f
, pattern
, size
, maxnames
)
9746 Lisp_Object pattern
;
9750 Lisp_Object list
= Qnil
, patterns
, newlist
= Qnil
, key
= Qnil
;
9751 Lisp_Object tem
, second_best
;
9752 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
9753 = f
? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) : x_display_list
;
9754 Display
*dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
9755 int try_XLoadQueryFont
= 0;
9756 int allow_auto_scaled_font
= 0;
9760 allow_auto_scaled_font
= 1;
9764 patterns
= Fassoc (pattern
, Valternate_fontname_alist
);
9765 if (NILP (patterns
))
9766 patterns
= Fcons (pattern
, Qnil
);
9768 if (maxnames
== 1 && !size
)
9769 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9770 try_XLoadQueryFont
= 1;
9772 for (; CONSP (patterns
); patterns
= XCDR (patterns
))
9775 char **names
= NULL
;
9777 pattern
= XCAR (patterns
);
9778 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9779 The cache is an alist of the form:
9780 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9781 tem
= XCDR (dpyinfo
->name_list_element
);
9782 key
= Fcons (Fcons (pattern
, make_number (maxnames
)),
9783 allow_auto_scaled_font
? Qt
: Qnil
);
9784 list
= Fassoc (key
, tem
);
9787 list
= Fcdr_safe (list
);
9788 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9792 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9795 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
9797 if (try_XLoadQueryFont
)
9800 unsigned long value
;
9802 font
= XLoadQueryFont (dpy
, SDATA (pattern
));
9803 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9805 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9806 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9808 x_clear_errors (dpy
);
9812 && XGetFontProperty (font
, XA_FONT
, &value
))
9814 char *name
= (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy
, (Atom
) value
);
9815 int len
= strlen (name
);
9818 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9819 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9820 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9822 try_XLoadQueryFont
= 0;
9826 names
= (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9827 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9829 tmp
= (char *) alloca (len
+ 1); names
[0] = tmp
;
9830 bcopy (name
, names
[0], len
+ 1);
9835 try_XLoadQueryFont
= 0;
9838 XFreeFont (dpy
, font
);
9841 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont
)
9843 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9844 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9851 names
= XListFonts (dpy
, SDATA (pattern
), limit
, &num_fonts
);
9852 if (num_fonts
== limit
)
9855 XFreeFontNames (names
);
9864 names
= XListFonts (dpy
, SDATA (pattern
), max (maxnames
, 10),
9867 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9869 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9870 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9872 x_clear_errors (dpy
);
9876 x_uncatch_errors ();
9883 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9884 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9885 for (i
= 0; i
< num_fonts
; i
++)
9889 int average_width
= -1, resx
= 0, dashes
= 0;
9891 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9892 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9893 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9894 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9895 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9896 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9901 if (dashes
== 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9903 else if (dashes
== 9)
9905 else if (dashes
== 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9906 average_width
= atoi (p
);
9909 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9910 || dashes
< 14 || average_width
!= 0 || resx
== 0)
9912 tem
= build_string (names
[i
]);
9913 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem
, list
)))
9915 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp
)
9916 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9917 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp
, names
[i
]))
9919 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9920 width of this font. */
9921 list
= Fcons (Fcons (tem
, make_number (width
)), list
);
9923 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9924 list
= Fcons (Fcons (tem
, Qnil
), list
);
9929 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont
)
9932 XFreeFontNames (names
);
9937 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9938 XSETCDR (dpyinfo
->name_list_element
,
9939 Fcons (Fcons (key
, list
), XCDR (dpyinfo
->name_list_element
)));
9942 if (NILP (list
)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9944 newlist
= second_best
= Qnil
;
9945 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9946 for (; CONSP (list
); list
= XCDR (list
))
9952 if (!CONSP (tem
) || NILP (XCAR (tem
)))
9956 newlist
= Fcons (XCAR (tem
), newlist
);
9960 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem
)))
9962 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9963 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9964 XFontStruct
*thisinfo
;
9967 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
9968 thisinfo
= XLoadQueryFont (dpy
,
9969 SDATA (XCAR (tem
)));
9970 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9972 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9973 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9975 x_clear_errors (dpy
);
9977 x_uncatch_errors ();
9983 (thisinfo
->min_bounds
.width
== 0
9985 : make_number (thisinfo
->max_bounds
.width
)));
9987 XFreeFont (dpy
, thisinfo
);
9991 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9992 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9993 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9994 XSETCDR (tem
, make_number (0));
9997 found_size
= XINT (XCDR (tem
));
9998 if (found_size
== size
)
9999 newlist
= Fcons (XCAR (tem
), newlist
);
10000 else if (found_size
> 0)
10002 if (NILP (second_best
))
10004 else if (found_size
< size
)
10006 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best
)) > size
10007 || XINT (XCDR (second_best
)) < found_size
)
10012 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best
)) > size
10013 && XINT (XCDR (second_best
)) > found_size
)
10018 if (!NILP (newlist
))
10020 else if (!NILP (second_best
))
10022 newlist
= Fcons (XCAR (second_best
), Qnil
);
10033 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
10037 x_check_font (f
, font
)
10042 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
10044 xassert (font
!= NULL
);
10046 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->n_fonts
; i
++)
10047 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
10048 && font
== dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].font
)
10051 xassert (i
< dpyinfo
->n_fonts
);
10054 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
10056 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
10057 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
10058 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
10059 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
10060 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
10063 x_font_min_bounds (font
, w
, h
)
10067 *h
= FONT_HEIGHT (font
);
10068 *w
= font
->min_bounds
.width
;
10070 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
10071 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
10072 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
10074 *w
= font
->max_bounds
.width
;
10078 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
10079 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
10080 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
10081 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
10082 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
10085 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f
)
10089 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
10091 int old_width
= dpyinfo
->smallest_char_width
;
10092 int old_height
= dpyinfo
->smallest_font_height
;
10094 dpyinfo
->smallest_font_height
= 100000;
10095 dpyinfo
->smallest_char_width
= 100000;
10097 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->n_fonts
; ++i
)
10098 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
)
10100 struct font_info
*fontp
= dpyinfo
->font_table
+ i
;
10103 font
= (XFontStruct
*) fontp
->font
;
10104 xassert (font
!= (XFontStruct
*) ~0);
10105 x_font_min_bounds (font
, &w
, &h
);
10107 dpyinfo
->smallest_font_height
= min (dpyinfo
->smallest_font_height
, h
);
10108 dpyinfo
->smallest_char_width
= min (dpyinfo
->smallest_char_width
, w
);
10111 xassert (dpyinfo
->smallest_char_width
> 0
10112 && dpyinfo
->smallest_font_height
> 0);
10114 return (dpyinfo
->n_fonts
== 1
10115 || dpyinfo
->smallest_char_width
< old_width
10116 || dpyinfo
->smallest_font_height
< old_height
);
10120 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
10121 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
10122 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
10123 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
10126 x_load_font (f
, fontname
, size
)
10128 register char *fontname
;
10131 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
10132 Lisp_Object font_names
;
10134 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
10135 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
10136 we already have by comparing names. */
10137 font_names
= x_list_fonts (f
, build_string (fontname
), size
, 1);
10139 if (!NILP (font_names
))
10144 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->n_fonts
; i
++)
10145 for (tail
= font_names
; CONSP (tail
); tail
= XCDR (tail
))
10146 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
10147 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
,
10148 SDATA (XCAR (tail
)))
10149 || !strcmp (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].full_name
,
10150 SDATA (XCAR (tail
)))))
10151 return (dpyinfo
->font_table
+ i
);
10154 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
10158 struct font_info
*fontp
;
10159 unsigned long value
;
10162 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
10163 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
10164 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
10165 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
10166 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
10167 if (size
> 0 && !NILP (font_names
))
10168 fontname
= (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names
));
10171 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
10172 font
= (XFontStruct
*) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), fontname
);
10173 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)))
10175 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10176 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10178 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
10180 x_uncatch_errors ();
10185 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
10186 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->n_fonts
; ++i
)
10187 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
== NULL
)
10190 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
10191 if (i
== dpyinfo
->n_fonts
10192 && dpyinfo
->n_fonts
== dpyinfo
->font_table_size
)
10195 dpyinfo
->font_table_size
= max (16, 2 * dpyinfo
->font_table_size
);
10196 sz
= dpyinfo
->font_table_size
* sizeof *dpyinfo
->font_table
;
10197 dpyinfo
->font_table
10198 = (struct font_info
*) xrealloc (dpyinfo
->font_table
, sz
);
10201 fontp
= dpyinfo
->font_table
+ i
;
10202 if (i
== dpyinfo
->n_fonts
)
10203 ++dpyinfo
->n_fonts
;
10205 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
10207 bzero (fontp
, sizeof (*fontp
));
10208 fontp
->font
= font
;
10209 fontp
->font_idx
= i
;
10210 fontp
->name
= (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname
) + 1);
10211 bcopy (fontname
, fontp
->name
, strlen (fontname
) + 1);
10213 if (font
->min_bounds
.width
== font
->max_bounds
.width
)
10215 /* Fixed width font. */
10216 fontp
->average_width
= fontp
->space_width
= font
->min_bounds
.width
;
10223 char2b
.byte1
= 0x00, char2b
.byte2
= 0x20;
10224 pcm
= x_per_char_metric (font
, &char2b
, 0);
10226 fontp
->space_width
= pcm
->width
;
10228 fontp
->space_width
= FONT_WIDTH (font
);
10230 fontp
->average_width
10231 = (XGetFontProperty (font
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
, &value
)
10232 ? (long) value
/ 10 : 0);
10233 if (fontp
->average_width
< 0)
10234 fontp
->average_width
= - fontp
->average_width
;
10235 if (fontp
->average_width
== 0)
10239 int width
= pcm
->width
;
10240 for (char2b
.byte2
= 33; char2b
.byte2
<= 126; char2b
.byte2
++)
10241 if ((pcm
= x_per_char_metric (font
, &char2b
, 0)) != NULL
)
10242 width
+= pcm
->width
;
10243 fontp
->average_width
= width
/ 95;
10246 fontp
->average_width
= FONT_WIDTH (font
);
10250 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
10252 if (XGetFontProperty (font
, XA_FONT
, &value
))
10254 char *name
= (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), (Atom
) value
);
10258 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
10259 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
10261 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
10272 full_name
= (char *) xmalloc (p
- name
+ 1);
10273 bcopy (name
, full_name
, p
- name
+ 1);
10279 if (full_name
!= 0)
10280 fontp
->full_name
= full_name
;
10282 fontp
->full_name
= fontp
->name
;
10284 fontp
->size
= font
->max_bounds
.width
;
10285 fontp
->height
= FONT_HEIGHT (font
);
10287 if (NILP (font_names
))
10289 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
10290 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
10291 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
10292 Lisp_Object lispy_name
= build_string (fontname
);
10293 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name
= build_string (fontp
->full_name
);
10294 Lisp_Object key
= Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name
, make_number (256)),
10297 XSETCDR (dpyinfo
->name_list_element
,
10299 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name
,
10300 make_number (fontp
->size
)),
10302 XCDR (dpyinfo
->name_list_element
)));
10305 key
= Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name
, make_number (256)),
10307 XSETCDR (dpyinfo
->name_list_element
,
10309 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name
,
10310 make_number (fontp
->size
)),
10312 XCDR (dpyinfo
->name_list_element
)));
10316 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
10317 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
10318 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
10319 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
10320 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
10321 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
10322 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
10323 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
10325 = (font
->max_byte1
== 0
10327 ? (font
->min_char_or_byte2
< 0x80
10328 ? (font
->max_char_or_byte2
< 0x80
10329 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
10330 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED
) /* 0x20..0xFF */
10331 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
10333 : (font
->min_byte1
< 0x80
10334 ? (font
->max_byte1
< 0x80
10335 ? (font
->min_char_or_byte2
< 0x80
10336 ? (font
->max_char_or_byte2
< 0x80
10337 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
10338 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED
) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
10339 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
10340 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED
) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
10341 : (font
->min_char_or_byte2
< 0x80
10342 ? (font
->max_char_or_byte2
< 0x80
10343 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
10344 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED
) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
10345 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
10347 fontp
->baseline_offset
10348 = (XGetFontProperty (font
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
, &value
)
10349 ? (long) value
: 0);
10350 fontp
->relative_compose
10351 = (XGetFontProperty (font
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
, &value
)
10352 ? (long) value
: 0);
10353 fontp
->default_ascent
10354 = (XGetFontProperty (font
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
, &value
)
10355 ? (long) value
: 0);
10357 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
10358 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
10359 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
10360 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
10361 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
10362 fonts_changed_p
|= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f
);
10369 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
10370 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
10373 x_query_font (f
, fontname
)
10375 register char *fontname
;
10377 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
10380 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->n_fonts
; i
++)
10381 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
10382 && (!xstricmp (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
, fontname
)
10383 || !xstricmp (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].full_name
, fontname
)))
10384 return (dpyinfo
->font_table
+ i
);
10389 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10390 `encoder' of the structure. */
10393 x_find_ccl_program (fontp
)
10394 struct font_info
*fontp
;
10396 Lisp_Object list
, elt
;
10399 for (list
= Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist
; CONSP (list
); list
= XCDR (list
))
10403 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt
))
10404 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt
), fontp
->name
)
10406 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt
), fontp
->full_name
)
10413 struct ccl_program
*ccl
10414 = (struct ccl_program
*) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program
));
10416 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl
, XCDR (elt
)) < 0)
10419 fontp
->font_encoder
= ccl
;
10425 /***********************************************************************
10427 ***********************************************************************/
10429 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10430 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options
[] = {
10431 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10432 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg
, (XtPointer
) "yes"},
10434 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10435 XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10436 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10438 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10439 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10440 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10441 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10442 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10443 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10444 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
}
10447 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10449 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
;
10451 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10453 static int x_initialized
;
10456 static int x_session_initialized
;
10459 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10460 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10461 the screen number from the server number. */
10463 same_x_server (name1
, name2
)
10464 const char *name1
, *name2
;
10466 int seen_colon
= 0;
10467 const unsigned char *system_name
= SDATA (Vsystem_name
);
10468 int system_name_length
= strlen (system_name
);
10469 int length_until_period
= 0;
10471 while (system_name
[length_until_period
] != 0
10472 && system_name
[length_until_period
] != '.')
10473 length_until_period
++;
10475 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10476 if (! strncmp (name1
, "unix:", 5))
10478 if (! strncmp (name2
, "unix:", 5))
10480 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10481 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
10482 && name1
[system_name_length
] == ':')
10483 name1
+= system_name_length
;
10484 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
10485 && name2
[system_name_length
] == ':')
10486 name2
+= system_name_length
;
10487 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10488 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
10489 && name1
[length_until_period
] == ':')
10490 name1
+= length_until_period
;
10491 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
10492 && name2
[length_until_period
] == ':')
10493 name2
+= length_until_period
;
10495 for (; *name1
!= '\0' && *name1
== *name2
; name1
++, name2
++)
10499 if (seen_colon
&& *name1
== '.')
10503 && (*name1
== '.' || *name1
== '\0')
10504 && (*name2
== '.' || *name2
== '\0'));
10508 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10509 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10512 get_bits_and_offset (mask
, bits
, offset
)
10513 unsigned long mask
;
10520 while (!(mask
& 1))
10536 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
10537 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
10540 x_display_ok (display
)
10541 const char *display
;
10546 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (display
);
10548 XCloseDisplay (dpy
);
10554 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
10555 the structure that describes the open display.
10556 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
10558 struct x_display_info
*
10559 x_term_init (display_name
, xrm_option
, resource_name
)
10560 Lisp_Object display_name
;
10562 char *resource_name
;
10566 struct terminal
*terminal
;
10567 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
10572 if (!x_initialized
)
10578 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name
)))
10579 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name
));
10583 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10585 char *argv
[NUM_ARGV
];
10586 char **argv2
= argv
;
10589 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
10590 if (!EQ (Vinitial_window_system
, intern ("x")))
10591 error ("Sorry, you cannot connect to X servers with the GTK toolkit");
10594 if (x_initialized
++ > 1)
10596 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
10597 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10598 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10599 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10600 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name
), &dpy
) < 0)
10602 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10606 for (argc
= 0; argc
< NUM_ARGV
; ++argc
)
10610 argv
[argc
++] = initial_argv
[0];
10612 if (! NILP (display_name
))
10614 argv
[argc
++] = "--display";
10615 argv
[argc
++] = SDATA (display_name
);
10618 argv
[argc
++] = "--name";
10619 argv
[argc
++] = resource_name
;
10621 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10623 gtk_init (&argc
, &argv2
);
10625 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10629 dpy
= GDK_DISPLAY ();
10631 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10632 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL
, event_handler_gdk
, NULL
);
10634 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10636 char *file
= "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10637 Lisp_Object s
, abs_file
;
10639 s
= make_string (file
, strlen (file
));
10640 abs_file
= Fexpand_file_name (s
, Qnil
);
10642 if (! NILP (abs_file
) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file
)))
10643 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file
));
10646 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
10647 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
10650 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10651 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10652 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10654 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10655 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10656 So let's not use it until R6. */
10657 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10658 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL
, NULL
, NULL
);
10669 argv
[argc
++] = "-xrm";
10670 argv
[argc
++] = xrm_option
;
10672 turn_on_atimers (0);
10673 dpy
= XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con
, SDATA (display_name
),
10674 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
,
10675 emacs_options
, XtNumber (emacs_options
),
10677 turn_on_atimers (1);
10679 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10680 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10685 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10686 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10687 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name
));
10688 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10689 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10691 /* Detect failure. */
10698 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10700 dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info
));
10701 bzero (dpyinfo
, sizeof *dpyinfo
);
10703 terminal
= x_create_terminal (dpyinfo
);
10705 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10707 struct x_display_info
*share
;
10710 for (share
= x_display_list
, tail
= x_display_name_list
; share
;
10711 share
= share
->next
, tail
= XCDR (tail
))
10712 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail
))),
10713 SDATA (display_name
)))
10716 terminal
->kboard
= share
->terminal
->kboard
;
10719 terminal
->kboard
= (KBOARD
*) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD
));
10720 init_kboard (terminal
->kboard
);
10721 terminal
->kboard
->Vwindow_system
= intern ("x");
10722 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
)->function
, Qunbound
))
10724 char *vendor
= ServerVendor (dpy
);
10726 terminal
->kboard
->Vsystem_key_alist
10727 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
,
10728 vendor
? build_string (vendor
) : empty_unibyte_string
);
10732 terminal
->kboard
->next_kboard
= all_kboards
;
10733 all_kboards
= terminal
->kboard
;
10734 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10735 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10736 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10737 if (current_kboard
== initial_kboard
)
10738 current_kboard
= terminal
->kboard
;
10740 terminal
->kboard
->reference_count
++;
10744 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10745 dpyinfo
->next
= x_display_list
;
10746 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
;
10748 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10749 x_display_name_list
= Fcons (Fcons (display_name
, Qnil
),
10750 x_display_name_list
);
10751 dpyinfo
->name_list_element
= XCAR (x_display_name_list
);
10753 dpyinfo
->display
= dpy
;
10755 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10756 terminal
->name
= (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name
) + 1);
10757 strncpy (terminal
->name
, SDATA (display_name
), SBYTES (display_name
));
10758 terminal
->name
[SBYTES (display_name
)] = 0;
10761 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display
, x_trace_wire
);
10765 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
)
10766 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name
)
10768 sprintf (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
, "%s@%s",
10769 SDATA (Vinvocation_name
), SDATA (Vsystem_name
));
10771 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10772 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
10774 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10776 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10777 dpyinfo
->xg_cursor
= xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo
->display
);
10778 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10780 dpyinfo
->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10781 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo
->display
, XC_sb_v_double_arrow
);
10783 xrdb
= x_load_resources (dpyinfo
->display
, xrm_option
,
10784 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
);
10785 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10786 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, xrdb
);
10788 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= xrdb
;
10790 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10792 dpyinfo
->xrdb
= xrdb
;
10794 dpyinfo
->screen
= ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
,
10795 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo
->display
));
10796 select_visual (dpyinfo
);
10797 dpyinfo
->cmap
= DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10798 dpyinfo
->height
= HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10799 dpyinfo
->width
= WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10800 dpyinfo
->root_window
= RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10801 dpyinfo
->client_leader_window
= 0;
10802 dpyinfo
->grabbed
= 0;
10803 dpyinfo
->reference_count
= 0;
10804 dpyinfo
->icon_bitmap_id
= -1;
10805 dpyinfo
->font_table
= NULL
;
10806 dpyinfo
->n_fonts
= 0;
10807 dpyinfo
->font_table_size
= 0;
10808 dpyinfo
->bitmaps
= 0;
10809 dpyinfo
->bitmaps_size
= 0;
10810 dpyinfo
->bitmaps_last
= 0;
10811 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= 0;
10812 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
10813 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
10814 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
= dpyinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
10815 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
= dpyinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
10816 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_face_id
= DEFAULT_FACE_ID
;
10817 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
10818 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_overlay
= Qnil
;
10819 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_x
= dpyinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_y
= 0;
10820 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_defer
= 0;
10821 dpyinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 0;
10822 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
10823 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
10824 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
10825 dpyinfo
->image_cache
= make_image_cache ();
10826 dpyinfo
->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
10828 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10829 dpyinfo
->red_bits
= dpyinfo
->blue_bits
= dpyinfo
->green_bits
= 0;
10830 dpyinfo
->red_offset
= dpyinfo
->blue_offset
= dpyinfo
->green_offset
= 0;
10832 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == TrueColor
)
10834 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->red_mask
,
10835 &dpyinfo
->red_bits
, &dpyinfo
->red_offset
);
10836 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->blue_mask
,
10837 &dpyinfo
->blue_bits
, &dpyinfo
->blue_offset
);
10838 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->green_mask
,
10839 &dpyinfo
->green_bits
, &dpyinfo
->green_offset
);
10842 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10843 if (dpyinfo
->visual
== DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
))
10845 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == PseudoColor
)
10848 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10849 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10850 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10852 if (STRINGP (value
)
10853 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value
), "true")
10854 || !strcmp (SDATA (value
), "on")))
10855 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->cmap
);
10859 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCreateColormap (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10860 dpyinfo
->visual
, AllocNone
);
10863 int screen_number
= XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10864 double pixels
= DisplayHeight (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10865 double mm
= DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10866 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10867 dpyinfo
->resy
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10868 pixels
= DisplayWidth (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10869 mm
= DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10870 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10871 dpyinfo
->resx
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10874 dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
10875 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False
);
10876 dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10877 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False
);
10878 dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10879 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False
);
10880 dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10881 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False
);
10882 dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_change_state
10883 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False
);
10884 dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10885 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False
);
10886 dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10887 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "WM_MOVED", False
);
10888 dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10889 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False
);
10890 dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
10891 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "Editres", False
);
10892 dpyinfo
->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10893 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "CLIPBOARD", False
);
10894 dpyinfo
->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10895 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "TIMESTAMP", False
);
10896 dpyinfo
->Xatom_TEXT
10897 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "TEXT", False
);
10898 dpyinfo
->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10899 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False
);
10900 dpyinfo
->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10901 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "UTF8_STRING", False
);
10902 dpyinfo
->Xatom_DELETE
10903 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "DELETE", False
);
10904 dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10905 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "MULTIPLE", False
);
10906 dpyinfo
->Xatom_INCR
10907 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "INCR", False
);
10908 dpyinfo
->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10909 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "_EMACS_TMP_", False
);
10910 dpyinfo
->Xatom_TARGETS
10911 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "TARGETS", False
);
10912 dpyinfo
->Xatom_NULL
10913 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "NULL", False
);
10914 dpyinfo
->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10915 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "ATOM_PAIR", False
);
10916 /* For properties of font. */
10917 dpyinfo
->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10918 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "PIXEL_SIZE", False
);
10919 dpyinfo
->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10920 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False
);
10921 dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10922 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False
);
10923 dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10924 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False
);
10925 dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10926 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False
);
10928 /* Ghostscript support. */
10929 dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
= XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "PAGE", False
);
10930 dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
= XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "DONE", False
);
10932 dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
= XInternAtom (dpyinfo
->display
, "SCROLLBAR",
10935 dpyinfo
->cut_buffers_initialized
= 0;
10937 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
= 8;
10938 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_length
= 0;
10939 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
= xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
)
10940 * dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
);
10942 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
10943 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
10944 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
10946 connection
= ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo
->display
);
10947 dpyinfo
->connection
= connection
;
10952 null_bits
[0] = 0x00;
10954 dpyinfo
->null_pixel
10955 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10956 null_bits
, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10961 extern int gray_bitmap_width
, gray_bitmap_height
;
10962 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits
;
10964 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10966 gray_bitmap_width
, gray_bitmap_height
,
10967 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10971 xim_initialize (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
10974 #ifdef subprocesses
10975 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10976 if (connection
!= 0)
10977 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection
);
10980 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10982 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10983 /* stdin is a socket here */
10984 fcntl (connection
, F_SETOWN
, -getpid ());
10985 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10986 fcntl (connection
, F_SETOWN
, getpid ());
10987 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10988 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10989 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10992 if (interrupt_input
)
10993 init_sigio (connection
);
10994 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10998 Display
*dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
10999 XrmValue d
, fr
, to
;
11002 d
.addr
= (XPointer
)&dpy
;
11003 d
.size
= sizeof (Display
*);
11004 fr
.addr
= XtDefaultFont
;
11005 fr
.size
= sizeof (XtDefaultFont
);
11006 to
.size
= sizeof (Font
*);
11007 to
.addr
= (XPointer
)&font
;
11008 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
11009 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy
, XtCvtStringToFont
, &d
, 1, &fr
, &to
, NULL
))
11011 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
) || !XQueryFont (dpy
, font
))
11012 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb
, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
11013 x_uncatch_errors ();
11017 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
11018 for debugging X code. */
11021 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
11022 build_string ("synchronous"),
11023 build_string ("Synchronous"),
11025 if (STRINGP (value
)
11026 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value
), "true")
11027 || !strcmp (SDATA (value
), "on")))
11028 XSynchronize (dpyinfo
->display
, True
);
11033 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
11034 build_string ("useXIM"),
11035 build_string ("UseXIM"),
11038 if (STRINGP (value
)
11039 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value
), "false")
11040 || !strcmp (SDATA (value
), "off")))
11043 if (STRINGP (value
)
11044 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value
), "true")
11045 || !strcmp (SDATA (value
), "on")))
11051 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
11052 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
11054 if (terminal
->id
== 1)
11055 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo
);
11063 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
11064 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
11067 x_delete_display (dpyinfo
)
11068 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
11071 struct terminal
*t
;
11073 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
11075 for (t
= terminal_list
; t
; t
= t
->next_terminal
)
11076 if (t
->type
== output_x_window
&& t
->display_info
.x
== dpyinfo
)
11079 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
11080 if (t
->id
== 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
11083 delete_terminal (t
);
11087 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo
->connection
);
11089 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
11090 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
11091 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list
)
11092 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list
), dpyinfo
->name_list_element
))
11093 x_display_name_list
= XCDR (x_display_name_list
);
11098 tail
= x_display_name_list
;
11099 while (CONSP (tail
) && CONSP (XCDR (tail
)))
11101 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail
)), dpyinfo
->name_list_element
))
11103 XSETCDR (tail
, XCDR (XCDR (tail
)));
11106 tail
= XCDR (tail
);
11110 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== dpyinfo
)
11111 next_noop_dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
;
11113 if (x_display_list
== dpyinfo
)
11114 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
->next
;
11117 struct x_display_info
*tail
;
11119 for (tail
= x_display_list
; tail
; tail
= tail
->next
)
11120 if (tail
->next
== dpyinfo
)
11121 tail
->next
= tail
->next
->next
;
11124 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
11125 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
11126 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo
->xrdb
);
11131 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo
);
11134 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
11135 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->n_fonts
; i
++)
11136 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
)
11138 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
!= dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].full_name
)
11139 xfree (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].full_name
);
11140 xfree (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
);
11143 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
)
11145 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
->font_encoder
)
11146 xfree (dpyinfo
->font_table
->font_encoder
);
11147 xfree (dpyinfo
->font_table
);
11149 if (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
)
11150 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
);
11151 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
)
11152 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
11156 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11158 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11159 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11160 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11161 that slows us down. */
11164 x_process_timeouts (timer
)
11165 struct atimer
*timer
;
11168 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 0;
11169 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
|| popup_activated ())
11171 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con
) & XtIMTimer
)
11172 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con
, XtIMTimer
);
11173 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11174 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11179 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11180 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11181 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11182 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11183 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11184 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11185 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11188 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
11191 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
)
11193 EMACS_TIME interval
;
11195 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval
, 0, 100000);
11196 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE
, interval
, x_process_timeouts
, 0);
11197 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 1;
11202 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11205 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11207 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers
[];
11209 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface
=
11211 x_frame_parm_handlers
,
11215 x_clear_end_of_line
,
11217 x_after_update_window_line
,
11218 x_update_window_begin
,
11219 x_update_window_end
,
11225 0, /* flush_display_optional */
11227 x_clear_window_mouse_face
,
11228 x_get_glyph_overhangs
,
11229 x_fix_overlapping_area
,
11230 x_draw_fringe_bitmap
,
11231 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11232 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11235 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs
,
11236 x_draw_glyph_string
,
11237 x_define_frame_cursor
,
11238 x_clear_frame_area
,
11239 x_draw_window_cursor
,
11240 x_draw_vertical_window_border
,
11241 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
11245 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
11247 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*terminal
)
11249 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= terminal
->display_info
.x
;
11252 /* Protect against recursive calls. Fdelete_frame in
11253 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
11254 if (!terminal
->name
)
11258 /* Free the fonts in the font table. */
11259 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->n_fonts
; i
++)
11260 if (dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].name
)
11262 XFreeFont (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->font_table
[i
].font
);
11265 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo
);
11266 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo
->display
, DestroyAll
);
11269 xg_display_close (dpyinfo
->display
);
11271 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11272 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
11274 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
11276 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
11278 x_delete_display (dpyinfo
);
11282 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
11283 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
11285 static struct terminal
*
11286 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
11288 struct terminal
*terminal
;
11290 terminal
= create_terminal ();
11292 terminal
->type
= output_x_window
;
11293 terminal
->display_info
.x
= dpyinfo
;
11294 dpyinfo
->terminal
= terminal
;
11296 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
11298 terminal
->clear_frame_hook
= x_clear_frame
;
11299 terminal
->ins_del_lines_hook
= x_ins_del_lines
;
11300 terminal
->delete_glyphs_hook
= x_delete_glyphs
;
11301 terminal
->ring_bell_hook
= XTring_bell
;
11302 terminal
->reset_terminal_modes_hook
= XTreset_terminal_modes
;
11303 terminal
->set_terminal_modes_hook
= XTset_terminal_modes
;
11304 terminal
->update_begin_hook
= x_update_begin
;
11305 terminal
->update_end_hook
= x_update_end
;
11306 terminal
->set_terminal_window_hook
= XTset_terminal_window
;
11307 terminal
->read_socket_hook
= XTread_socket
;
11308 terminal
->frame_up_to_date_hook
= XTframe_up_to_date
;
11309 terminal
->mouse_position_hook
= XTmouse_position
;
11310 terminal
->frame_rehighlight_hook
= XTframe_rehighlight
;
11311 terminal
->frame_raise_lower_hook
= XTframe_raise_lower
;
11312 terminal
->fullscreen_hook
= XTfullscreen_hook
;
11313 terminal
->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook
= XTset_vertical_scroll_bar
;
11314 terminal
->condemn_scroll_bars_hook
= XTcondemn_scroll_bars
;
11315 terminal
->redeem_scroll_bar_hook
= XTredeem_scroll_bar
;
11316 terminal
->judge_scroll_bars_hook
= XTjudge_scroll_bars
;
11318 terminal
->delete_frame_hook
= x_destroy_window
;
11319 terminal
->delete_terminal_hook
= x_delete_terminal
;
11321 terminal
->rif
= &x_redisplay_interface
;
11322 terminal
->scroll_region_ok
= 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
11323 terminal
->char_ins_del_ok
= 1;
11324 terminal
->line_ins_del_ok
= 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
11325 terminal
->fast_clear_end_of_line
= 1; /* X does this well. */
11326 terminal
->memory_below_frame
= 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
11338 last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
11339 any_help_event_p
= 0;
11340 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
11342 x_session_initialized
= 0;
11346 current_count
= -1;
11349 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11350 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt
);
11352 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11353 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11355 Xt_app_con
= XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11357 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11358 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11359 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con
,
11360 XtRString
, XtRPixel
, cvt_string_to_pixel
,
11361 cvt_string_to_pixel_args
,
11362 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args
),
11363 XtCacheByDisplay
, cvt_pixel_dtor
);
11365 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con
, Xt_default_resources
);
11368 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11370 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= False
;
11371 xaw3d_pick_top
= True
;
11375 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11376 original error handler. */
11377 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
11378 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
11380 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
11381 #if 0 /* Don't. We may want to open tty frames later. */
11383 signal (SIGWINCH
, SIG_DFL
);
11384 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
11387 signal (SIGPIPE
, x_connection_signal
);
11394 x_error_message
= NULL
;
11396 staticpro (&x_display_name_list
);
11397 x_display_name_list
= Qnil
;
11399 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar
);
11400 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
11402 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms
);
11403 Qvendor_specific_keysyms
= intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
11405 staticpro (&Qutf_8
);
11406 Qutf_8
= intern ("utf-8");
11407 staticpro (&Qlatin_1
);
11408 Qlatin_1
= intern ("latin-1");
11410 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame
);
11411 last_mouse_press_frame
= Qnil
;
11413 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11414 &x_use_underline_position_properties
,
11415 doc
: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11416 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11417 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11418 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
11419 x_use_underline_position_properties
= 1;
11421 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11422 &x_underline_at_descent_line
,
11423 doc
: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11424 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
11425 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
11426 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
11427 x_underline_at_descent_line
= 0;
11429 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11430 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
,
11431 doc
: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11432 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11433 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11434 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11435 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11436 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11437 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
= 0;
11439 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
,
11440 doc
: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
11441 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
11442 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
11443 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11445 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern ("motif");
11446 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11447 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern ("xaw3d");
11449 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern ("gtk");
11451 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern ("xaw");
11454 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= Qnil
;
11457 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame
);
11458 last_mouse_motion_frame
= Qnil
;
11460 Qmodifier_value
= intern ("modifier-value");
11461 Qalt
= intern ("alt");
11462 Fput (Qalt
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (alt_modifier
));
11463 Qhyper
= intern ("hyper");
11464 Fput (Qhyper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (hyper_modifier
));
11465 Qmeta
= intern ("meta");
11466 Fput (Qmeta
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (meta_modifier
));
11467 Qsuper
= intern ("super");
11468 Fput (Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (super_modifier
));
11470 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym
,
11471 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11472 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11473 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11474 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11475 Vx_alt_keysym
= Qnil
;
11477 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym
,
11478 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11479 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11480 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11481 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11482 Vx_hyper_keysym
= Qnil
;
11484 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym
,
11485 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11486 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11487 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11488 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11489 Vx_meta_keysym
= Qnil
;
11491 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym
,
11492 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11493 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11494 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11495 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11496 Vx_super_keysym
= Qnil
;
11498 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table
,
11499 doc
: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11500 Vx_keysym_table
= make_hash_table (Qeql
, make_number (900),
11501 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE
),
11502 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD
),
11506 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
11508 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
11509 (do not change this comment) */